]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blame - gdb/doc/gdb.texinfo
Change EM_MSP430 value to new, officially assigned number.
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c 1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
b6ba6518 2@c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
1e698235 3@c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003
c906108c
SS
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
5d161b24 6@c %**start of header
c906108c
SS
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
c906108c 13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
41afff9a 25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
48e934c6 26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
c906108c 27@syncodeindex vr cp
41afff9a 28@syncodeindex fn cp
c906108c
SS
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
e9c75b65 31@set EDITION Ninth
c906108c
SS
32
33@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
87885426
FN
34@set DATE June 2002
35
36@c !!set GDB edit command default editor
37@set EDITOR /bin/ex
c906108c 38
6c0e9fb3 39@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
c906108c 40
c906108c 41@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
6d2ebf8b 42@c manuals to an info tree.
96a2c332
SS
43@dircategory Programming & development tools.
44@direntry
c906108c 45* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
96a2c332
SS
46@end direntry
47
c906108c
SS
48@ifinfo
49This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
50
51
5d161b24 52This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
c906108c
SS
53of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
54for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
55
8a037dd7 56Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
1e698235 57 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 58
e9c75b65
EZ
59Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
60under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
61any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
62Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
63Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
64and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
c906108c 65
6826cf00
EZ
66(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
67freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
68published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
69development.''
c906108c
SS
70@end ifinfo
71
72@titlepage
73@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
74@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 75@sp 1
c906108c
SS
76@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
77@subtitle @value{DATE}
9e9c5ae7 78@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
c906108c 79@page
c906108c
SS
80@tex
81{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 82\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
83\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
84\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
85}
86@end tex
53a5351d 87
c906108c 88@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
8a037dd7 89Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
1e698235 901996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 91@sp 2
c906108c
SS
92Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9359 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
94Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
6d2ebf8b 95ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
e9c75b65
EZ
96
97Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
98under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
99any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
100Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
101Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
102and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
e9c75b65 103
6826cf00
EZ
104(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
105freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
106published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
107development.''
c906108c
SS
108@end titlepage
109@page
110
6c0e9fb3 111@ifnottex
6d2ebf8b
SS
112@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
113
c906108c
SS
114@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
115
116This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
117
5d161b24 118This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
c906108c
SS
119@value{GDBVN}.
120
1e698235 121Copyright (C) 1988-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6d2ebf8b
SS
122
123@menu
124* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
125* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
126
127* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
128* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
129* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
130* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
131* Stack:: Examining the stack
132* Source:: Examining source files
133* Data:: Examining data
e2e0bcd1 134* Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
b37052ae 135* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
df0cd8c5 136* Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
6d2ebf8b
SS
137
138* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
139
140* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
141* Altering:: Altering execution
142* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
143* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
6b2f586d 144* Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
6d2ebf8b
SS
145* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
146* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
147* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c4555f82 148* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
6d2ebf8b
SS
149* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
150* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
7162c0ca 151* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
6d2ebf8b
SS
152
153* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
154* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
155
156* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
157* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
158* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
eb12ee30 159* Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
e0ce93ac 160* Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
aab4e0ec
AC
161* Copying:: GNU General Public License says
162 how you can copy and share GDB
6826cf00 163* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
6d2ebf8b
SS
164* Index:: Index
165@end menu
166
6c0e9fb3 167@end ifnottex
c906108c 168
449f3b6c 169@contents
449f3b6c 170
6d2ebf8b 171@node Summary
c906108c
SS
172@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
173
174The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
175going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
176program was doing at the moment it crashed.
177
178@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
179these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
180
181@itemize @bullet
182@item
183Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
184
185@item
186Make your program stop on specified conditions.
187
188@item
189Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
190
191@item
192Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
193effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
194@end itemize
195
cce74817 196You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 197For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
198For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
199
cce74817 200@cindex Modula-2
e632838e
AC
201Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
202@ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
c906108c 203
cce74817
JM
204@cindex Pascal
205Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
206nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
207entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
208syntax.
c906108c 209
c906108c
SS
210@cindex Fortran
211@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 212it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 213underscore.
c906108c 214
c906108c
SS
215@menu
216* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
217* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
218@end menu
219
6d2ebf8b 220@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
221@unnumberedsec Free software
222
5d161b24 223@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
c906108c
SS
224General Public License
225(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
226program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
227freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
228the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
229Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
230Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
231
232Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
233you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
234from anyone else.
235
2666264b 236@unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
959acfd1
EZ
237
238The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
239the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
240include with the free software. Many of our most important
241programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
242texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
243when an important free software package does not come with a free
244manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
245gaps today.
246
247Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
248normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
249authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
250copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
251them from the free software world.
252
253That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
254from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
255manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
256only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
257contract to make it non-free.
258
259Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
260price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
261charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
262Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
263problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
264are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
265modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
266
267The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
268free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
269commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
270accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
271
272Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
273When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
274are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
275provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
276manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
277a changed version of the program is not really available to our
278community.
279
280Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
281acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
282author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
283authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
284to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
285may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
286with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
287are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
288of the manual.
289
290However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
291content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
292media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
293obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
294manual to replace it.
295
296Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
297lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
298free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
299the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
300realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
301the free software community.
302
303If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
304the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
305license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
306don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
307will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
308option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
309what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
310try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
42584a72 311is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
959acfd1
EZ
312
313You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
314manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
315copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
316improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
317at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
318and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
72c9928d
EZ
319Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
320have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
959acfd1
EZ
321
322The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
323published by other publishers, at
324@url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
325
6d2ebf8b 326@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
327@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
328
329Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
330other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
331development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
332of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
333to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
334file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
335blow-by-blow account.
336
337Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
338
339@quotation
340@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
341or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
342omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
343@end quotation
344
345So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
346particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
347releases:
299ffc64 348Andrew Cagney (releases 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
c906108c
SS
349Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
350Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
351Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
352Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
353Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
354John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
355Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
356and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
357
358Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
359Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
360
b37052ae
EZ
361Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
362in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
363Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
364demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
365much general update work leading to release 3.0).
c906108c 366
b37052ae 367@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
c906108c
SS
368object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
369Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
370
371David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
372the original support for encapsulated COFF.
373
96c405b3 374Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
c906108c
SS
375
376Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
377Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
378support.
379Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
380Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
381Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
382David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
383Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
384Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
385Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
386Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
387Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
388Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
389Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
390Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
391Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
392Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
393Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
a37295f9 394Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
c906108c 395
1104b9e7 396Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
c906108c
SS
397
398Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
399libraries.
400
401Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
402about several machine instruction sets.
403
404Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
405remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
406contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
407and RDI targets, respectively.
408
409Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
410command-line editing and command history.
411
7a292a7a
SS
412Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
413Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c 414
5d161b24 415Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
b37052ae 416He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
c906108c 417symbols.
c906108c
SS
418
419Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
420Super-H processors.
421
422NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
423
424Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
425
426Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
427
428Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
429
96a2c332 430Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
431
432Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
433watchpoints.
434
435Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
436
437Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
438
439Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 440nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
441
442The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
443support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
b37052ae 444(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
c906108c
SS
445compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
446John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
447Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
448information in this manual.
449
b37052ae
EZ
450DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
451Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
452
96a2c332
SS
453Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
454development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
455fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
456Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
457Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
458Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
459Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
460addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
461JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
462Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
463Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
464Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
465Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
466Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
467Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c 468
e2e0bcd1
JB
469Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
470Hat.
c906108c 471
6d2ebf8b 472@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
473@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
474
475You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
476However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
477debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
478
479@iftex
480In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
481to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
482@end iftex
483
484@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
485@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
486
487One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
488processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
489quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
490definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
491session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
492then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
493same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
494@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
495procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
496
497@smallexample
498$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
499$ @b{./m4}
500@b{define(foo,0000)}
501
502@b{foo}
5030000
504@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
505
506@b{bar}
5070000
508@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
509
510@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
511@b{baz}
512@b{C-d}
513m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
514@end smallexample
515
516@noindent
517Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
518
c906108c
SS
519@smallexample
520$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
521@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
522@c FIXME... format to come out better.
523@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 524 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
c906108c 525 the conditions.
5d161b24 526There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
c906108c
SS
527 for details.
528
529@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
530(@value{GDBP})
531@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
532
533@noindent
534@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
535rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
536We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
537that examples fit in this manual.
538
539@smallexample
540(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
541@end smallexample
542
543@noindent
544We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
545Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
546@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
547@code{break} command.
548
549@smallexample
550(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
551Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
552@end smallexample
553
554@noindent
555Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
556control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
557subroutine, the program runs as usual:
558
559@smallexample
560(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
561Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
562@b{define(foo,0000)}
563
564@b{foo}
5650000
566@end smallexample
567
568@noindent
569To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
570suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
571context where it stops.
572
573@smallexample
574@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
575
5d161b24 576Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
577 at builtin.c:879
578879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
579@end smallexample
580
581@noindent
582Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
583the next line of the current function.
584
585@smallexample
586(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
587882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
588 : nil,
589@end smallexample
590
591@noindent
592@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
593by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
594@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
595subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
596
597@smallexample
598(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
599set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
600 at input.c:530
601530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
602@end smallexample
603
604@noindent
605The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
606suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
607shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
608command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
609in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
610stack frame for each active subroutine.
611
612@smallexample
613(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
614#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
615 at input.c:530
5d161b24 616#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
617 at builtin.c:882
618#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
619#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
620 at macro.c:71
621#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
622#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
623@end smallexample
624
625@noindent
626We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
627times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
628falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
629
630@smallexample
631(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6320x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
633(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6340x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
635def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
636(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
637536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
638 : xstrdup(rq);
639(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
640538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
641@end smallexample
642
643@noindent
644The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
645@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
646and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
647(@code{print}) to see their values.
648
649@smallexample
650(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
651$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
652(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
653$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
654@end smallexample
655
656@noindent
657@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
658To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
659surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
660
661@smallexample
662(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
663533 xfree(rquote);
664534
665535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
666 : xstrdup (lq);
667536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
668 : xstrdup (rq);
669537
670538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
671539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
672540 @}
673541
674542 void
675@end smallexample
676
677@noindent
678Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
679@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
680
681@smallexample
682(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
683539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
684(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
685540 @}
686(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
687$3 = 9
688(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
689$4 = 7
690@end smallexample
691
692@noindent
693That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
694@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
695@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
696the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
697any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
698assignments.
699
700@smallexample
701(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
702$5 = 7
703(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
704$6 = 9
705@end smallexample
706
707@noindent
708Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
709@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
710executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
711example that caused trouble initially:
712
713@smallexample
714(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
715Continuing.
716
717@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
718
719baz
7200000
721@end smallexample
722
723@noindent
724Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
725problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
726lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
727
728@smallexample
729@b{C-d}
730Program exited normally.
731@end smallexample
732
733@noindent
734The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
735indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
736session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
737
738@smallexample
739(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
740@end smallexample
c906108c 741
6d2ebf8b 742@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
743@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
744
745This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
5d161b24 746The essentials are:
c906108c 747@itemize @bullet
5d161b24 748@item
53a5351d 749type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
5d161b24 750@item
c906108c
SS
751type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
752@end itemize
753
754@menu
755* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
756* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
757* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
758@end menu
759
6d2ebf8b 760@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
761@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
762
c906108c
SS
763Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
764@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
765
766You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
767to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
768
c906108c
SS
769The command-line options described here are designed
770to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
5d161b24 771options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
772
773The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
774specifying an executable program:
775
474c8240 776@smallexample
c906108c 777@value{GDBP} @var{program}
474c8240 778@end smallexample
c906108c 779
c906108c
SS
780@noindent
781You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
782specified:
783
474c8240 784@smallexample
c906108c 785@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
474c8240 786@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
787
788You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
789to debug a running process:
790
474c8240 791@smallexample
c906108c 792@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
474c8240 793@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
794
795@noindent
796would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
797named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
798
c906108c 799Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
800complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
801debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
802``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
803will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 804
aa26fa3a
TT
805You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
806executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
807option processing.
474c8240 808@smallexample
aa26fa3a 809gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
474c8240 810@end smallexample
aa26fa3a
TT
811This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
812@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
813
96a2c332 814You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
815@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
816
817@smallexample
818@value{GDBP} -silent
819@end smallexample
820
821@noindent
822You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
823options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
824
825@noindent
826Type
827
474c8240 828@smallexample
c906108c 829@value{GDBP} -help
474c8240 830@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
831
832@noindent
833to display all available options and briefly describe their use
834(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
835
836All options and command line arguments you give are processed
837in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
838@samp{-x} option is used.
839
840
841@menu
c906108c
SS
842* File Options:: Choosing files
843* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
844@end menu
845
6d2ebf8b 846@node File Options
c906108c
SS
847@subsection Choosing files
848
2df3850c 849When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
850specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
851the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
19837790
MS
852@samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
853first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
854equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
855second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
856equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
857If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
858first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
859to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
860a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
79f12247 861prefixing it with @file{./}, eg. @file{./12345}.
7a292a7a
SS
862
863If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
864such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
865argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
866
867Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
868following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
869them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
870(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
871than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
872
d700128c
EZ
873@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
874@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
875@c it.
876
c906108c
SS
877@table @code
878@item -symbols @var{file}
879@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
880@cindex @code{--symbols}
881@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
882Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
883
884@item -exec @var{file}
885@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
886@cindex @code{--exec}
887@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
888Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
889and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
890
891@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 892@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
893Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
894file.
895
c906108c
SS
896@item -core @var{file}
897@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
898@cindex @code{--core}
899@cindex @code{-c}
19837790 900Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
c906108c
SS
901
902@item -c @var{number}
19837790
MS
903@item -pid @var{number}
904@itemx -p @var{number}
905@cindex @code{--pid}
906@cindex @code{-p}
907Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
908If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
909file named @var{number}.
c906108c
SS
910
911@item -command @var{file}
912@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
913@cindex @code{--command}
914@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
915Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
916Files,, Command files}.
917
918@item -directory @var{directory}
919@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
920@cindex @code{--directory}
921@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
922Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
923
c906108c
SS
924@item -m
925@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
926@cindex @code{--mapped}
927@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
928@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
929supported on all systems.}@*
930If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
5d161b24 931system call, you can use this option
c906108c
SS
932to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
933program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 934called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
935Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
936and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
937the symbol table from the executable program.
938
939The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
940is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
941table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 942
c906108c
SS
943@item -r
944@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
945@cindex @code{--readnow}
946@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
947Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
948the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
949This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 950
c906108c
SS
951@end table
952
2df3850c 953You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 954order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
955information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
956on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
957but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c 958
474c8240 959@smallexample
2df3850c 960gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
474c8240 961@end smallexample
c906108c 962
6d2ebf8b 963@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
964@subsection Choosing modes
965
966You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
967batch mode or quiet mode.
968
969@table @code
970@item -nx
971@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
972@cindex @code{--nx}
973@cindex @code{-n}
96565e91 974Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
2df3850c
JM
975@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
976options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
977files}.
c906108c
SS
978
979@item -quiet
d700128c 980@itemx -silent
c906108c 981@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
982@cindex @code{--quiet}
983@cindex @code{--silent}
984@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
985``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
986messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
987
988@item -batch
d700128c 989@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
990Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
991command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
992initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
993nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
994in the command files.
995
2df3850c
JM
996Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
997example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
998make this more useful, the message
c906108c 999
474c8240 1000@smallexample
c906108c 1001Program exited normally.
474c8240 1002@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1003
1004@noindent
2df3850c
JM
1005(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1006@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1007mode.
1008
1009@item -nowindows
1010@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
1011@cindex @code{--nowindows}
1012@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 1013``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 1014(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
1015interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1016
1017@item -windows
1018@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
1019@cindex @code{--windows}
1020@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
1021If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1022used if possible.
c906108c
SS
1023
1024@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 1025@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
1026Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1027instead of the current directory.
1028
c906108c
SS
1029@item -fullname
1030@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
1031@cindex @code{--fullname}
1032@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
1033@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1034subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1035number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1036displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1037recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1038the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1039and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1040@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1041frame.
c906108c 1042
d700128c
EZ
1043@item -epoch
1044@cindex @code{--epoch}
1045The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1046@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1047routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1048separate window.
1049
1050@item -annotate @var{level}
1051@cindex @code{--annotate}
1052This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1053effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1054(@pxref{Annotations}).
1055Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
1056together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
1057types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
1058@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
1059maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
1060
1061@item -async
1062@cindex @code{--async}
1063Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1064@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
1065special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
1066commands in parallel with the debugged process being
1067run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
1068MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1069suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1070control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
b37052ae 1071(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
d700128c
EZ
1072operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1073yet.)
1074@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1075@c should be removed.
1076
1077When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1078uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1079@samp{-noasync} option.
1080
1081@item -noasync
1082@cindex @code{--noasync}
1083Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1084
aa26fa3a
TT
1085@item --args
1086@cindex @code{--args}
1087Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1088executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1089This option stops option processing.
1090
2df3850c
JM
1091@item -baud @var{bps}
1092@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
1093@cindex @code{--baud}
1094@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
1095Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1096interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
1097
1098@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
1099@itemx -t @var{device}
1100@cindex @code{--tty}
1101@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
1102Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1103@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 1104
53a5351d 1105@c resolve the situation of these eventually
c4555f82
SC
1106@item -tui
1107@cindex @code{--tui}
1108Activate the Terminal User Interface when starting.
1109The Terminal User Interface manages several text windows on the terminal,
1110showing source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1111(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).
1112Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs
1113(@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
53a5351d
JM
1114
1115@c @item -xdb
d700128c 1116@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
1117@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1118@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1119@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1120@c systems.
1121
d700128c
EZ
1122@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1123@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1124Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1125program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
94bbb2c0
AC
1126communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1127
da0f9dcd
AC
1128@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1129@value{GDBN} to use the current @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface}
1130(@pxref{GDB/MI, , The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}). The previous @sc{gdb/mi}
1131interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3, can be selected with
1132@samp{--interpreter=mi1}. Earlier @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces
1133are not supported.
d700128c
EZ
1134
1135@item -write
1136@cindex @code{--write}
1137Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1138is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1139(@pxref{Patching}).
1140
1141@item -statistics
1142@cindex @code{--statistics}
1143This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1144memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1145
1146@item -version
1147@cindex @code{--version}
1148This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1149no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1150
c906108c
SS
1151@end table
1152
6d2ebf8b 1153@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1154@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1155@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1156@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1157
1158@table @code
1159@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
41afff9a 1160@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
96a2c332
SS
1161@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1162@itemx q
1163To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1164@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1165do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1166otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1167error code.
c906108c
SS
1168@end table
1169
1170@cindex interrupt
1171An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1172terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1173returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1174character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1175until a time when it is safe.
1176
c906108c
SS
1177If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1178device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1179(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1180
6d2ebf8b 1181@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1182@section Shell commands
1183
1184If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1185debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1186just use the @code{shell} command.
1187
1188@table @code
1189@kindex shell
1190@cindex shell escape
1191@item shell @var{command string}
1192Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1193If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1194shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1195(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1196@end table
1197
1198The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1199You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1200@value{GDBN}:
1201
1202@table @code
1203@kindex make
1204@cindex calling make
1205@item make @var{make-args}
1206Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1207arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1208@end table
1209
6d2ebf8b 1210@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1211@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1212
1213You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1214name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1215@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1216key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1217show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1218
1219@menu
1220* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1221* Completion:: Command completion
1222* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1223@end menu
1224
6d2ebf8b 1225@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1226@section Command syntax
1227
1228A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1229how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1230arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1231command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1232step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1233with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1234
1235@cindex abbreviation
1236@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1237unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1238documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1239abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1240equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1241names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1242arguments to the @code{help} command.
1243
1244@cindex repeating commands
41afff9a 1245@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
c906108c 1246A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1247repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1248will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1249repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1250repeat.
1251
1252The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1253@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1254exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1255
1256@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1257output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1258(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1259@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1260repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1261
41afff9a 1262@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
c906108c
SS
1263@cindex comment
1264Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1265nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1266Files,,Command files}).
1267
88118b3a
TT
1268@cindex repeating command sequences
1269@kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1270The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1271commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1272then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1273for editing.
1274
6d2ebf8b 1275@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1276@section Command completion
1277
1278@cindex completion
1279@cindex word completion
1280@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1281only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1282are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1283commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1284
1285Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1286of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1287word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1288enter it). For example, if you type
1289
1290@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1291@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1292@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1293@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
474c8240 1294@smallexample
c906108c 1295(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
474c8240 1296@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1297
1298@noindent
1299@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1300the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1301
474c8240 1302@smallexample
c906108c 1303(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
474c8240 1304@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1305
1306@noindent
1307You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1308breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1309@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1310were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1311might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1312to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1313
1314If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1315@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1316characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1317@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1318example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1319begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1320just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1321function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1322example:
1323
474c8240 1324@smallexample
c906108c
SS
1325(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1326@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
5d161b24
DB
1327make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1328make_abs_section make_function_type
1329make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1330make_cleanup make_reference_type
c906108c
SS
1331make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1332(@value{GDBP}) b make_
474c8240 1333@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1334
1335@noindent
1336After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1337partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1338command.
1339
1340If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
b37052ae 1341can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1342means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1343key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1344one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1345
1346@cindex quotes in commands
1347@cindex completion of quoted strings
1348Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1349parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1350its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1351situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1352@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1353
c906108c 1354The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
b37052ae
EZ
1355name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1356overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1357by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1358may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1359that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1360that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1361word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1362@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1363@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1364when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
c906108c 1365
474c8240 1366@smallexample
96a2c332 1367(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1368bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1369(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
474c8240 1370@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1371
1372In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1373quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1374completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1375place:
1376
474c8240 1377@smallexample
c906108c
SS
1378(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1379@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1380(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
474c8240 1381@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1382
1383@noindent
1384In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1385you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1386completion on an overloaded symbol.
1387
d4f3574e 1388For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
b37052ae 1389expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
c906108c 1390overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
b37052ae 1391see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c
SS
1392
1393
6d2ebf8b 1394@node Help
c906108c
SS
1395@section Getting help
1396@cindex online documentation
1397@kindex help
1398
5d161b24 1399You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
c906108c
SS
1400using the command @code{help}.
1401
1402@table @code
41afff9a 1403@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
c906108c
SS
1404@item help
1405@itemx h
1406You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1407display a short list of named classes of commands:
1408
1409@smallexample
1410(@value{GDBP}) help
1411List of classes of commands:
1412
2df3850c 1413aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1414breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1415data -- Examining data
c906108c 1416files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1417internals -- Maintenance commands
1418obscure -- Obscure features
1419running -- Running the program
1420stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1421status -- Status inquiries
1422support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1423tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1424 stopping the program
c906108c 1425user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c 1426
5d161b24 1427Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
c906108c 1428commands in that class.
5d161b24 1429Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1430documentation.
1431Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1432(@value{GDBP})
1433@end smallexample
96a2c332 1434@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1435
1436@item help @var{class}
1437Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1438list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1439help display for the class @code{status}:
1440
1441@smallexample
1442(@value{GDBP}) help status
1443Status inquiries.
1444
1445List of commands:
1446
1447@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1448@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1449info -- Generic command for showing things
1450 about the program being debugged
1451show -- Generic command for showing things
1452 about the debugger
c906108c 1453
5d161b24 1454Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1455documentation.
1456Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1457(@value{GDBP})
1458@end smallexample
1459
1460@item help @var{command}
1461With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1462short paragraph on how to use that command.
1463
6837a0a2
DB
1464@kindex apropos
1465@item apropos @var{args}
1466The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1467commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1468@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1469
1470@smallexample
1471apropos reload
1472@end smallexample
1473
b37052ae
EZ
1474@noindent
1475results in:
6837a0a2
DB
1476
1477@smallexample
6d2ebf8b
SS
1478@c @group
1479set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1480 multiple times in one run
1481show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1482 multiple times in one run
1483@c @end group
6837a0a2
DB
1484@end smallexample
1485
c906108c
SS
1486@kindex complete
1487@item complete @var{args}
1488The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1489for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1490command you want completed. For example:
1491
1492@smallexample
1493complete i
1494@end smallexample
1495
1496@noindent results in:
1497
1498@smallexample
1499@group
2df3850c
JM
1500if
1501ignore
c906108c
SS
1502info
1503inspect
c906108c
SS
1504@end group
1505@end smallexample
1506
1507@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1508@end table
1509
1510In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1511and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1512of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1513manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1514under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1515all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1516
1517@c @group
1518@table @code
1519@kindex info
41afff9a 1520@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
c906108c
SS
1521@item info
1522This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1523program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1524with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1525registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1526You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1527@w{@code{help info}}.
1528
1529@kindex set
1530@item set
5d161b24 1531You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
c906108c
SS
1532@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1533@code{set prompt $}.
1534
1535@kindex show
1536@item show
5d161b24 1537In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
c906108c
SS
1538@value{GDBN} itself.
1539You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1540related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1541system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1542which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1543
1544@kindex info set
1545To display all the settable parameters and their current
1546values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1547@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1548@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1549@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1550@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1551@end table
1552@c @end group
1553
1554Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1555exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1556
1557@table @code
1558@kindex show version
1559@cindex version number
1560@item show version
1561Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1562information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1563@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1564version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1565commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1566system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1567variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1568The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1569@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1570
1571@kindex show copying
1572@item show copying
1573Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1574
1575@kindex show warranty
1576@item show warranty
2df3850c 1577Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1578if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1579
c906108c
SS
1580@end table
1581
6d2ebf8b 1582@node Running
c906108c
SS
1583@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1584
1585When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1586debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1587
1588You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1589of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1590your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1591kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1592
1593@menu
1594* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1595* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1596* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1597* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1598
1599* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1600* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1601* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1602* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1603
1604* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1605* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1606@end menu
1607
6d2ebf8b 1608@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1609@section Compiling for debugging
1610
1611In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1612debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1613is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1614variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1615and addresses in the executable code.
1616
1617To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1618the compiler.
1619
e2e0bcd1
JB
1620Most compilers do not include information about preprocessor macros in
1621the debugging information if you specify the @option{-g} flag alone,
1622because this information is rather large. Version 3.1 of @value{NGCC},
1623the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you specify the
1624options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1625debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1626``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact ways
1627to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1628@option{-g} alone.
1629
c906108c
SS
1630Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1631options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1632executables containing debugging information.
1633
53a5351d
JM
1634@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1635without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1636recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1637program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1638in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1639
1640@cindex optimized code, debugging
1641@cindex debugging optimized code
1642When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1643optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1644really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1645exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1646variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1647variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1648
1649Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1650@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1651doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1652please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1653
1654Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1655@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1656format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1657
1658@need 2000
6d2ebf8b 1659@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1660@section Starting your program
1661@cindex starting
1662@cindex running
1663
1664@table @code
1665@kindex run
41afff9a 1666@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
c906108c
SS
1667@item run
1668@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1669Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1670You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1671argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1672@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1673(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1674
1675@end table
1676
c906108c
SS
1677If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1678supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1679that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1680@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1681
1682The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1683receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1684information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1685can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1686your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1687divided into four categories:
1688
1689@table @asis
1690@item The @emph{arguments.}
1691Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1692@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1693is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1694(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1695the arguments.
1696In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1697@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1698@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1699
1700@item The @emph{environment.}
1701Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1702use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1703environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1704your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1705
1706@item The @emph{working directory.}
1707Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1708the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1709@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1710
1711@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1712Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1713standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1714in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1715set a different device for your program.
1716@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1717
1718@cindex pipes
1719@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1720pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1721program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1722wrong program.
1723@end table
c906108c
SS
1724
1725When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1726immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1727of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1728stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1729or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1730
1731If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1732time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1733table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1734your current breakpoints.
1735
6d2ebf8b 1736@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1737@section Your program's arguments
1738
1739@cindex arguments (to your program)
1740The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
5d161b24 1741@code{run} command.
c906108c
SS
1742They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1743performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1744@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1745@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1746the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1747
1748On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1749@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1750calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1751the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1752
1753@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1754@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1755
c906108c 1756@table @code
41afff9a 1757@kindex set args
c906108c
SS
1758@item set args
1759Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1760@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1761with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1762using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1763it again without arguments.
1764
1765@kindex show args
1766@item show args
1767Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1768@end table
1769
6d2ebf8b 1770@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1771@section Your program's environment
1772
1773@cindex environment (of your program)
1774The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1775their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1776your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1777path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1778the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1779debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1780environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1781
1782@table @code
1783@kindex path
1784@item path @var{directory}
1785Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
17cc6a06
EZ
1786(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1787The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
d4f3574e
SS
1788You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1789system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1790MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1791is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1792
1793You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1794working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1795use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1796@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1797@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1798@var{directory} to the search path.
1799@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1800@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1801
1802@kindex show paths
1803@item show paths
1804Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1805environment variable).
1806
1807@kindex show environment
1808@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1809Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1810your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1811print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1812your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1813
1814@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1815@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1816Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1817changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1818be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1819any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1820parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1821null value.
1822@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1823@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1824
1825For example, this command:
1826
474c8240 1827@smallexample
c906108c 1828set env USER = foo
474c8240 1829@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1830
1831@noindent
d4f3574e 1832tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1833@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1834are not actually required.)
1835
1836@kindex unset environment
1837@item unset environment @var{varname}
1838Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1839program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1840@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1841rather than assigning it an empty value.
1842@end table
1843
d4f3574e
SS
1844@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1845the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1846by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1847@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1848that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1849@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1850your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1851files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1852@file{.profile}.
1853
6d2ebf8b 1854@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1855@section Your program's working directory
1856
1857@cindex working directory (of your program)
1858Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1859working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1860The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1861from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1862working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1863
1864The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1865that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1866specify files}.
1867
1868@table @code
1869@kindex cd
1870@item cd @var{directory}
1871Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1872
1873@kindex pwd
1874@item pwd
1875Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1876@end table
1877
6d2ebf8b 1878@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1879@section Your program's input and output
1880
1881@cindex redirection
1882@cindex i/o
1883@cindex terminal
1884By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
5d161b24 1885the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
c906108c
SS
1886to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1887modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1888running your program.
1889
1890@table @code
1891@kindex info terminal
1892@item info terminal
1893Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1894program is using.
1895@end table
1896
1897You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1898redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1899
474c8240 1900@smallexample
c906108c 1901run > outfile
474c8240 1902@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1903
1904@noindent
1905starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1906
1907@kindex tty
1908@cindex controlling terminal
1909Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1910with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1911argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1912commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1913process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1914
474c8240 1915@smallexample
c906108c 1916tty /dev/ttyb
474c8240 1917@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1918
1919@noindent
1920directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1921default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1922that as their controlling terminal.
1923
1924An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1925effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1926terminal.
1927
1928When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1929command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1930for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1931
6d2ebf8b 1932@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1933@section Debugging an already-running process
1934@kindex attach
1935@cindex attach
1936
1937@table @code
1938@item attach @var{process-id}
1939This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1940outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1941targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1942find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1943or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1944
1945@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1946executing the command.
1947@end table
1948
1949To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1950which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1951programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1952also have permission to send the process a signal.
1953
1954When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1955the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1956the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1957(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1958the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1959Specify Files}.
1960
1961The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1962process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1963with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1964you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1965can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1966process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1967attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1968
1969@table @code
1970@kindex detach
1971@item detach
1972When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1973@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1974the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1975that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1976are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1977@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1978executing the command.
1979@end table
1980
1981If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1982attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1983for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1984control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1985confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1986messages}).
1987
6d2ebf8b 1988@node Kill Process
c906108c 1989@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1990
1991@table @code
1992@kindex kill
1993@item kill
1994Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1995@end table
1996
1997This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1998running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1999is running.
2000
2001On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2002while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2003@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2004outside the debugger.
2005
2006The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2007relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2008executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2009next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2010reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2011breakpoint settings).
2012
6d2ebf8b 2013@node Threads
c906108c 2014@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
2015
2016@cindex threads of execution
2017@cindex multiple threads
2018@cindex switching threads
2019In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2020may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2021of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2022the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2023that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2024modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2025registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2026
2027@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2028programs:
2029
2030@itemize @bullet
2031@item automatic notification of new threads
2032@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2033@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
5d161b24 2034@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
c906108c
SS
2035a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2036@item thread-specific breakpoints
2037@end itemize
2038
c906108c
SS
2039@quotation
2040@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2041@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2042If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2043effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2044from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2045like this:
2046
2047@smallexample
2048(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2049(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2050Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2051see the IDs of currently known threads.
2052@end smallexample
2053@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2054@c doesn't support threads"?
2055@end quotation
c906108c
SS
2056
2057@cindex focus of debugging
2058@cindex current thread
2059The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2060threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2061control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2062This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2063program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2064
41afff9a 2065@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
c906108c
SS
2066@cindex thread identifier (system)
2067@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2068@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2069@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2070Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2071the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2072form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2073whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2074LynxOS, you might see
2075
474c8240 2076@smallexample
c906108c 2077[New process 35 thread 27]
474c8240 2078@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2079
2080@noindent
2081when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2082the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2083further qualifier.
2084
2085@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2086@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
6ca652b0 2087@c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
c906108c
SS
2088@c program?
2089@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2090@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
5d161b24 2091@c threads ab initio?
c906108c
SS
2092
2093@cindex thread number
2094@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2095For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2096number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2097
2098@table @code
2099@kindex info threads
2100@item info threads
2101Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2102program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2103
2104@enumerate
2105@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2106
2107@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2108
2109@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2110@end enumerate
2111
2112@noindent
2113An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2114indicates the current thread.
2115
5d161b24 2116For example,
c906108c
SS
2117@end table
2118@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2119
2120@smallexample
2121(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2122 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2123 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2124* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2125 at threadtest.c:68
2126@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
2127
2128On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
2129
2130@cindex thread number
2131@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2132For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2133number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2134thread in your program.
2135
41afff9a
EZ
2136@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2137@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
c906108c
SS
2138@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2139@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2140@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2141Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2142both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2143form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2144whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2145HP-UX, you see
2146
474c8240 2147@smallexample
c906108c 2148[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
474c8240 2149@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2150
2151@noindent
5d161b24 2152when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
c906108c
SS
2153
2154@table @code
2155@kindex info threads
2156@item info threads
2157Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2158program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2159
2160@enumerate
2161@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2162
2163@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2164
2165@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2166@end enumerate
2167
2168@noindent
2169An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2170indicates the current thread.
2171
5d161b24 2172For example,
c906108c
SS
2173@end table
2174@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2175
474c8240 2176@smallexample
c906108c 2177(@value{GDBP}) info threads
6d2ebf8b
SS
2178 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2179 at quicksort.c:137
2180 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2181 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2182 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2183 from /usr/lib/libc.2
474c8240 2184@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2185
2186@table @code
2187@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2188@item thread @var{threadno}
2189Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2190argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2191shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2192@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2193you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2194
2195@smallexample
2196@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2197(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2198[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
21990x34e5 in sigpause ()
2200@end smallexample
2201
2202@noindent
2203As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2204@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
5d161b24 2205threads.
c906108c
SS
2206
2207@kindex thread apply
2208@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2209The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2210more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2211with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2212@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
5d161b24
DB
2213threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2214@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
c906108c
SS
2215@end table
2216
2217@cindex automatic thread selection
2218@cindex switching threads automatically
2219@cindex threads, automatic switching
2220Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2221signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2222signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2223message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2224thread.
2225
2226@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2227more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2228programs with multiple threads.
2229
2230@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2231watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2232
6d2ebf8b 2233@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2234@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2235
2236@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2237@cindex multiple processes
2238@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2239On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2240programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2241function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2242parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2243set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2244will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2245will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2246
2247However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2248which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2249the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2250only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2251so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2252on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2253get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2254@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2255the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2256the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2257
53a5351d
JM
2258On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2259debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2260@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2261
2262By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2263the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2264
2265If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2266use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2267
2268@table @code
2269@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2270@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2271Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2272@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2273process. The @var{mode} can be:
2274
2275@table @code
2276@item parent
2277The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2278unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2279
2280@item child
2281The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2282unimpeded.
2283
2284@item ask
2285The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2286@end table
2287
2288@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2289Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2290@end table
2291
2292If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2293@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2294breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2295@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2296the child process's @code{main}.
2297
2298When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2299child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2300
2301If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2302call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2303use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2304argument.
2305
2306You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2307a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2308Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2309
6d2ebf8b 2310@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2311@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2312
2313The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2314program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2315trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2316
7a292a7a
SS
2317Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2318such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2319@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2320change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2321continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2322ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2323explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2324
2325@table @code
2326@kindex info program
2327@item info program
2328Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2329running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2330@end table
2331
2332@menu
2333* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2334* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2335* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2336* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2337@end menu
2338
6d2ebf8b 2339@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2340@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2341
2342@cindex breakpoints
2343A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2344the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2345control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2346breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2347Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2348should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2349program.
2350
2351In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2352breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2353a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2354is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2355not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2356arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2357
2358@cindex watchpoints
2359@cindex memory tracing
2360@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2361@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2362A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2363when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2364command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2365watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2366any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2367and watchpoints using the same commands.
2368
2369You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2370whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2371Automatic display}.
2372
2373@cindex catchpoints
2374@cindex breakpoint on events
2375A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
b37052ae 2376when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
2377exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2378different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2379catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2380other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2381@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2382
2383@cindex breakpoint numbers
2384@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2385@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2386catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2387starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2388features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2389breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2390@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2391enable it again.
2392
c5394b80
JM
2393@cindex breakpoint ranges
2394@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2395Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2396operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2397@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2398hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2399all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2400
c906108c
SS
2401@menu
2402* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2403* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2404* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2405* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2406* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2407* Conditions:: Break conditions
2408* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2409* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2410* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2411@end menu
2412
6d2ebf8b 2413@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2414@subsection Setting breakpoints
2415
5d161b24 2416@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
c906108c
SS
2417@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2418@c
2419@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2420
2421@kindex break
41afff9a
EZ
2422@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2423@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
2424@cindex latest breakpoint
2425Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
5d161b24 2426@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
f3b28801 2427number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
c906108c
SS
2428Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2429convenience variables.
2430
2431You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2432
2433@table @code
2434@item break @var{function}
5d161b24 2435Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c 2436When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
b37052ae 2437C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
c906108c 2438@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2439
2440@item break +@var{offset}
2441@itemx break -@var{offset}
2442Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2443at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2444(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2445
2446@item break @var{linenum}
2447Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2448The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2449The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2450code on that line.
2451
2452@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2453Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2454
2455@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2456Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2457@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2458superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2459functions.
2460
2461@item break *@var{address}
2462Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2463breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2464information or source files.
2465
2466@item break
2467When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2468the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2469(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2470innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2471returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2472@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2473that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2474@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2475the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2476inside loops.
2477
2478@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2479least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2480would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2481breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2482existed when your program stopped.
2483
2484@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2485Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2486@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2487value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2488@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2489above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2490,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2491
2492@kindex tbreak
2493@item tbreak @var{args}
2494Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2495same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2496way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2497program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2498
c906108c
SS
2499@kindex hbreak
2500@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2501Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2502@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2503breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2504have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2505debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2506changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2507provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2508will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2509address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2510breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2511example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2512@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2513or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2514(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2515
2516@kindex thbreak
2517@item thbreak @var{args}
2518Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2519are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
5d161b24 2520the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
c906108c
SS
2521the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2522first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
5d161b24
DB
2523command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2524may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2525See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2526
2527@kindex rbreak
2528@cindex regular expression
2529@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2530Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2531@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2532matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2533breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2534the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2535them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2536
2537The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2538like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2539shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2540an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2541@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2542match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2543
b37052ae 2544When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
c906108c
SS
2545breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2546classes.
c906108c
SS
2547
2548@kindex info breakpoints
2549@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2550@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2551@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2552@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2553Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2554not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2555
2556@table @emph
2557@item Breakpoint Numbers
2558@item Type
2559Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2560@item Disposition
2561Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2562@item Enabled or Disabled
2563Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2564that are not enabled.
2565@item Address
2df3850c 2566Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2567@item What
2568Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2569line number.
2570@end table
2571
2572@noindent
2573If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2574the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2575are listed after that.
2576
2577@noindent
2578@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2579number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2580convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2581the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
5d161b24 2582listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
c906108c
SS
2583
2584@noindent
2585@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2586has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2587@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2588hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2589was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2590will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2591@end table
2592
2593@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2594your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2595the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2596(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2597
2598@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2599@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
eb12ee30
AC
2600@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
2601special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
2602programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
2603starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
c906108c 2604You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
eb12ee30 2605@samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
c906108c
SS
2606
2607
6d2ebf8b 2608@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2609@subsection Setting watchpoints
2610
2611@cindex setting watchpoints
2612@cindex software watchpoints
2613@cindex hardware watchpoints
2614You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2615expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2616this may happen.
2617
2618Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2619hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2620program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2621times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2622catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2623culprit.)
2624
1104b9e7 2625On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2626@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2627hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2628program.
2629
2630@table @code
2631@kindex watch
2632@item watch @var{expr}
2633Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2634is written into by the program and its value changes.
2635
2636@kindex rwatch
2637@item rwatch @var{expr}
2638Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2639
2640@kindex awatch
2641@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2642Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2643by the program.
c906108c
SS
2644
2645@kindex info watchpoints
2646@item info watchpoints
2647This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2648it is the same as @code{info break}.
2649@end table
2650
2651@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2652watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2653value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2654cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2655executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2656statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2657
2658When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2659
474c8240 2660@smallexample
c906108c 2661Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
474c8240 2662@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2663
2664@noindent
2665if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2666
7be570e7
JM
2667Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2668hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2669value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2670every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2671that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2672hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2673will print a message like this:
2674
2675@smallexample
2676Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2677@end smallexample
2678
2679Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2680data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2681watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2682can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2683cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2684double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2685wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2686into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2687
2688If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2689to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2690Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2691time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2692able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2693warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2694
2695@smallexample
2696Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2697@end smallexample
2698
2699@noindent
2700If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2701
2702The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2703or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2704data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2705hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2706both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2707watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2708@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2709watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2710@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2711Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2712
2713If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2714any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2715kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2716
7be570e7
JM
2717@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2718(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2719they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2720which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2721being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2722and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2723rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2724way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2725@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2726
c906108c
SS
2727@quotation
2728@cindex watchpoints and threads
2729@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2730@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2731usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2732can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2733you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2734thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2735can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2736@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2737the expression.
53a5351d 2738
d4f3574e 2739@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2740@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2741have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2742watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2743single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2744change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2745confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2746software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2747when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2748watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2749@end quotation
c906108c 2750
6d2ebf8b 2751@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2752@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2753@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2754@cindex exception handlers
2755@cindex event handling
2756
2757You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
b37052ae 2758kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
c906108c
SS
2759shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2760
2761@table @code
2762@kindex catch
2763@item catch @var{event}
2764Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2765@table @code
2766@item throw
2767@kindex catch throw
b37052ae 2768The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2769
2770@item catch
2771@kindex catch catch
b37052ae 2772The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2773
2774@item exec
2775@kindex catch exec
2776A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2777
2778@item fork
2779@kindex catch fork
2780A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2781
2782@item vfork
2783@kindex catch vfork
2784A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2785
2786@item load
2787@itemx load @var{libname}
2788@kindex catch load
2789The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2790@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2791
2792@item unload
2793@itemx unload @var{libname}
2794@kindex catch unload
2795The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2796of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2797@end table
2798
2799@item tcatch @var{event}
2800Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2801automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2802
2803@end table
2804
2805Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2806
b37052ae 2807There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
2808(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2809
2810@itemize @bullet
2811@item
2812If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2813control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2814raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2815returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2816simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2817that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2818you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2819disabled within interactive calls.
2820
2821@item
2822You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2823
2824@item
2825You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2826@end itemize
2827
2828@cindex raise exceptions
2829Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2830if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2831stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2832can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2833breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2834out where the exception was raised.
2835
2836To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
b37052ae 2837knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
c906108c
SS
2838raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2839which has the following ANSI C interface:
2840
474c8240 2841@smallexample
c906108c 2842 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2843 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2844 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
474c8240 2845@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2846
2847@noindent
2848To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2849unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2850(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2851
2852With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2853that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2854a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2855breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2856raised.
2857
2858
6d2ebf8b 2859@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2860@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2861
2862@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2863@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2864It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2865catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2866to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2867breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2868
2869With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2870where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2871delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2872their breakpoint numbers.
2873
2874It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2875automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2876when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2877
2878@table @code
2879@kindex clear
2880@item clear
2881Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2882selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2883the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2884breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2885
2886@item clear @var{function}
2887@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2888Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2889
2890@item clear @var{linenum}
2891@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2892Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2893
2894@cindex delete breakpoints
2895@kindex delete
41afff9a 2896@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
c5394b80
JM
2897@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2898Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2899ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2900breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2901confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2902@end table
2903
6d2ebf8b 2904@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2905@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2906
2907@kindex disable breakpoints
2908@kindex enable breakpoints
2909Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2910prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2911it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2912that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2913
2914You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2915the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2916or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2917@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2918catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2919
2920A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2921states of enablement:
2922
2923@itemize @bullet
2924@item
2925Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2926with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2927@item
2928Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2929@item
2930Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2931disabled.
c906108c
SS
2932@item
2933Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2934immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2935set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2936@end itemize
2937
2938You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2939watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2940
2941@table @code
2942@kindex disable breakpoints
2943@kindex disable
41afff9a 2944@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
c5394b80 2945@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2946Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2947listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2948options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2949case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2950@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2951
2952@kindex enable breakpoints
2953@kindex enable
c5394b80 2954@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2955Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2956become effective once again in stopping your program.
2957
c5394b80 2958@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2959Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2960of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2961
c5394b80 2962@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2963Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2964deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2965@end table
2966
d4f3574e
SS
2967@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2968@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2969Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2970,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2971subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2972the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2973breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2974breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2975stepping}.)
2976
6d2ebf8b 2977@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2978@subsection Break conditions
2979@cindex conditional breakpoints
2980@cindex breakpoint conditions
2981
2982@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5d161b24 2983@c in particular for a watchpoint?
c906108c
SS
2984The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2985specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2986breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2987programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2988a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2989and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2990
2991This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2992situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2993when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2994by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2995@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2996
2997Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2998since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2999it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3000and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3001one.
3002
3003Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3004your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3005that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3006format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3007unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3008that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3009program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
3010breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3011conditions for the
c906108c
SS
3012purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3013(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3014
3015Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3016@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3017Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3018with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 3019
c906108c
SS
3020You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3021The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3022@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3023catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
3024
3025@table @code
3026@kindex condition
3027@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3028Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3029watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3030breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3031@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3032@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3033syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
3034referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3035symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3036prints an error message:
3037
474c8240 3038@smallexample
d4f3574e 3039No symbol "foo" in current context.
474c8240 3040@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3041
3042@noindent
c906108c
SS
3043@value{GDBN} does
3044not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
3045command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3046@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
3047
3048@item condition @var{bnum}
3049Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3050an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3051@end table
3052
3053@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3054A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3055breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3056useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3057count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3058is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3059therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3060ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3061the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3062value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3063your program reaches it.
3064
3065@table @code
3066@kindex ignore
3067@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3068Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3069The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3070execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3071takes no action.
3072
3073To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3074a count of zero.
3075
3076When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3077breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3078@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3079Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3080
3081If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3082condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3083@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3084
3085You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3086as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3087is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3088variables}.
3089@end table
3090
3091Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3092
3093
6d2ebf8b 3094@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
3095@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3096
3097@cindex breakpoint commands
3098You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3099commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3100example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3101enable other breakpoints.
3102
3103@table @code
3104@kindex commands
3105@kindex end
3106@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3107@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3108@itemx end
3109Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3110themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3111@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3112
3113To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3114follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3115
3116With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3117breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3118recently encountered).
3119@end table
3120
3121Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3122disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3123
3124You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3125use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3126that resumes execution.
3127
3128Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3129execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3130(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3131another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3132ambiguities about which list to execute.
3133
3134@kindex silent
3135If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3136usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3137be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3138then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3139see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3140meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3141
3142The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3143print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3144breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3145
3146For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3147value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3148
474c8240 3149@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3150break foo if x>0
3151commands
3152silent
3153printf "x is %d\n",x
3154cont
3155end
474c8240 3156@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3157
3158One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3159you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3160of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3161erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3162to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3163so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3164command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3165
474c8240 3166@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3167break 403
3168commands
3169silent
3170set x = y + 4
3171cont
3172end
474c8240 3173@end smallexample
c906108c 3174
6d2ebf8b 3175@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3176@subsection Breakpoint menus
3177@cindex overloading
3178@cindex symbol overloading
3179
b37052ae 3180Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
c906108c
SS
3181to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3182This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3183@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3184a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3185something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3186particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3187you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3188waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3189options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3190sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3191@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3192breakpoints.
3193
3194For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3195breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3196We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3197
3198@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3199@smallexample
3200@group
3201(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3202[0] cancel
3203[1] all
3204[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3205[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3206[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3207[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3208[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3209[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3210> 2 4 6
3211Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3212Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3213Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3214Multiple breakpoints were set.
3215Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3216 breakpoints.
3217(@value{GDBP})
3218@end group
3219@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3220
3221@c @ifclear BARETARGET
6d2ebf8b 3222@node Error in Breakpoints
d4f3574e 3223@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3224@c
3225@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3226@c
d4f3574e
SS
3227Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3228any other process is running that program. In this situation,
5d161b24 3229attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
d4f3574e
SS
3230@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3231
474c8240 3232@smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3233Cannot insert breakpoints.
3234The same program may be running in another process.
474c8240 3235@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3236
3237When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3238
3239@enumerate
3240@item
3241Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3242
3243@item
5d161b24 3244Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
d4f3574e 3245name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
5d161b24 3246that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
d4f3574e
SS
3247Then start your program again.
3248
3249@item
3250Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3251linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3252to nonsharable executables.
3253@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3254@c @end ifclear
3255
d4f3574e
SS
3256A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3257hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3258
3259@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3260@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3261@smallexample
3262Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3263You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3264@end smallexample
3265
3266@noindent
3267This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3268only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3269watchpoints it needs to insert.
3270
3271When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3272hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3273
3274
6d2ebf8b 3275@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3276@section Continuing and stepping
3277
3278@cindex stepping
3279@cindex continuing
3280@cindex resuming execution
3281@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3282completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3283one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3284line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3285particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3286your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3287it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3288@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3289
3290@table @code
3291@kindex continue
41afff9a
EZ
3292@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3293@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
c906108c
SS
3294@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3295@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3296@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3297Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3298any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3299@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3300ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3301@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3302
3303The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3304stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3305@code{continue} is ignored.
3306
d4f3574e
SS
3307The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3308debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3309purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3310@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3311@end table
3312
3313To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3314(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3315calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3316different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3317
3318A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3319(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3320beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3321is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3322and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3323interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3324
3325@table @code
3326@kindex step
41afff9a 3327@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
c906108c
SS
3328@item step
3329Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3330line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3331abbreviated @code{s}.
3332
3333@quotation
3334@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3335@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3336@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3337@c distinction here.
3338@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3339within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3340execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3341debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3342is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3343without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3344below.
3345@end quotation
3346
4a92d011
EZ
3347The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3348line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3349@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3350to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3351the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3352called within the line.
c906108c 3353
d4f3574e
SS
3354Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3355number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5d161b24 3356@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
c906108c 3357on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5d161b24 3358was any debugging information about the routine.
c906108c
SS
3359
3360@item step @var{count}
3361Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3362breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3363@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3364
3365@kindex next
41afff9a 3366@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
c906108c
SS
3367@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3368Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3369This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3370the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3371control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3372that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3373is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3374
3375An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3376
3377
3378@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3379@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3380@c
3381@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3382@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3383@c function are executed without stopping.
3384
d4f3574e
SS
3385The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3386source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4a92d011 3387@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
c906108c 3388
b90a5f51
CF
3389@kindex set step-mode
3390@item set step-mode
3391@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3392@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3393@itemx set step-mode on
4a92d011 3394The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
b90a5f51
CF
3395stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3396information rather than stepping over it.
3397
4a92d011
EZ
3398This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3399machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3400want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
b90a5f51
CF
3401
3402@item set step-mode off
4a92d011 3403Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
b90a5f51
CF
3404debug information. This is the default.
3405
c906108c
SS
3406@kindex finish
3407@item finish
3408Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3409returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3410
3411Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3412,Returning from a function}).
3413
3414@kindex until
41afff9a 3415@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
c906108c
SS
3416@item until
3417@itemx u
3418Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3419current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3420stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3421command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3422automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3423than the address of the jump.
3424
3425This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3426though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3427exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3428simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3429through the next iteration.
3430
3431@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3432stack frame.
3433
3434@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3435of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3436example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3437(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3438@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3439
474c8240 3440@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3441(@value{GDBP}) f
3442#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3443206 expand_input();
3444(@value{GDBP}) until
3445195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
474c8240 3446@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3447
3448This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3449generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3450start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3451written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3452to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3453expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3454statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3455
3456@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3457instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3458argument.
3459
3460@item until @var{location}
3461@itemx u @var{location}
3462Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3463reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3464the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3465,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3466and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3467
3468@kindex stepi
41afff9a 3469@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
c906108c 3470@item stepi
96a2c332 3471@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3472@itemx si
3473Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3474
3475It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3476instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3477instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3478Display,, Automatic display}.
3479
3480An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3481
3482@need 750
3483@kindex nexti
41afff9a 3484@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
c906108c 3485@item nexti
96a2c332 3486@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3487@itemx ni
3488Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3489proceed until the function returns.
3490
3491An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3492@end table
3493
6d2ebf8b 3494@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3495@section Signals
3496@cindex signals
3497
3498A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3499operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3500kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3501signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3502@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3503memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3504the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3505requested an alarm).
3506
3507@cindex fatal signals
3508Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3509functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3510errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3511program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3512@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3513fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3514
3515@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3516program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3517signal.
3518
3519@cindex handling signals
24f93129
EZ
3520Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3521@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3522(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
c906108c
SS
3523but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3524You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3525
3526@table @code
3527@kindex info signals
3528@item info signals
96a2c332 3529@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3530Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3531handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3532the defined types of signals.
3533
d4f3574e 3534@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3535
3536@kindex handle
3537@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
5ece1a18
EZ
3538Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3539can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
24f93129 3540@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5ece1a18
EZ
3541@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3542known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
c906108c
SS
3543@end table
3544
3545@c @group
3546The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3547Their full names are:
3548
3549@table @code
3550@item nostop
3551@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3552still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3553
3554@item stop
3555@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3556the @code{print} keyword as well.
3557
3558@item print
3559@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3560
3561@item noprint
3562@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3563implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3564
3565@item pass
5ece1a18 3566@itemx noignore
c906108c
SS
3567@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3568can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5ece1a18 3569and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3570
3571@item nopass
5ece1a18 3572@itemx ignore
c906108c 3573@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5ece1a18 3574@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3575@end table
3576@c @end group
3577
d4f3574e
SS
3578When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3579program until you
c906108c
SS
3580continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3581effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3582after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3583command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3584program sees that signal when you continue.
3585
24f93129
EZ
3586The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3587non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3588@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3589erroneous signals.
3590
c906108c
SS
3591You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3592seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3593or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3594due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3595values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3596execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3597a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3598you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5d161b24 3599program a signal}.
c906108c 3600
6d2ebf8b 3601@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3602@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3603
3604When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3605programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3606breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3607
3608@table @code
3609@cindex breakpoints and threads
3610@cindex thread breakpoints
3611@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3612@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3613@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3614@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3615writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3616
3617Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3618to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3619particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3620numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3621column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3622
3623If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3624breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3625program.
3626
3627You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3628well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3629breakpoint condition, like this:
3630
3631@smallexample
2df3850c 3632(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3633@end smallexample
3634
3635@end table
3636
3637@cindex stopped threads
3638@cindex threads, stopped
3639Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3640@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3641allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3642switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3643underfoot.
3644
3645@cindex continuing threads
3646@cindex threads, continuing
3647Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3648executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5d161b24 3649like @code{step} or @code{next}.
c906108c
SS
3650
3651In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3652Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3653system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3654execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3655single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3656statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3657stops.
3658
3659You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3660continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3661thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3662first thread completes whatever you requested.
3663
3664On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3665thread to run.
3666
3667@table @code
3668@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3669Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3670locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3671current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3672mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3673``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3674stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3675when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3676function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3677like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3678thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3679@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3680
3681@item show scheduler-locking
3682Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3683@end table
3684
c906108c 3685
6d2ebf8b 3686@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3687@chapter Examining the Stack
3688
3689When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3690stopped and how it got there.
3691
3692@cindex call stack
5d161b24
DB
3693Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3694is generated.
3695That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3696the arguments of the call,
c906108c 3697and the local variables of the function being called.
5d161b24 3698The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
c906108c
SS
3699The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3700stack}.
3701
3702When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3703stack allow you to see all of this information.
3704
3705@cindex selected frame
3706One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3707@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3708particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3709your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3710special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3711interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3712
3713When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5d161b24 3714currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
c906108c
SS
3715@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3716
3717@menu
3718* Frames:: Stack frames
3719* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3720* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3721* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3722
3723@end menu
3724
6d2ebf8b 3725@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3726@section Stack frames
3727
d4f3574e 3728@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3729@cindex stack frame
3730The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3731frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3732with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3733to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3734which the function is executing.
3735
3736@cindex initial frame
3737@cindex outermost frame
3738@cindex innermost frame
3739When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3740function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3741@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3742made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3743is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3744the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3745actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3746recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3747
3748@cindex frame pointer
3749Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3750stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3751kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3752address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3753in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3754going on in that frame.
3755
3756@cindex frame number
3757@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3758zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3759and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3760they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3761frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3762
6d2ebf8b
SS
3763@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3764@c underflow problems.
c906108c
SS
3765@cindex frameless execution
3766Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6d2ebf8b 3767without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
474c8240 3768@smallexample
6d2ebf8b 3769@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
474c8240 3770@end smallexample
6d2ebf8b 3771generates functions without a frame.)
c906108c
SS
3772This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3773the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3774with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3775has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3776it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3777correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3778no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3779
3780@table @code
d4f3574e 3781@kindex frame@r{, command}
41afff9a 3782@cindex current stack frame
c906108c 3783@item frame @var{args}
5d161b24 3784The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
c906108c 3785and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5d161b24
DB
3786address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3787@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
c906108c
SS
3788
3789@kindex select-frame
41afff9a 3790@cindex selecting frame silently
c906108c
SS
3791@item select-frame
3792The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3793to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3794@code{frame}.
3795@end table
3796
6d2ebf8b 3797@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3798@section Backtraces
3799
3800@cindex backtraces
3801@cindex tracebacks
3802@cindex stack traces
3803A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3804line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3805frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3806stack.
3807
3808@table @code
3809@kindex backtrace
41afff9a 3810@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
c906108c
SS
3811@item backtrace
3812@itemx bt
3813Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3814frames in the stack.
3815
3816You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3817character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3818
3819@item backtrace @var{n}
3820@itemx bt @var{n}
3821Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3822
3823@item backtrace -@var{n}
3824@itemx bt -@var{n}
3825Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3826@end table
3827
3828@kindex where
3829@kindex info stack
41afff9a 3830@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
c906108c
SS
3831The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3832are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3833
3834Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3835The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3836print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3837line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3838counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3839line number.
3840
3841Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3842@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3843
3844@smallexample
3845@group
5d161b24 3846#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
c906108c
SS
3847 at builtin.c:993
3848#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3849#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3850 at macro.c:71
3851(More stack frames follow...)
3852@end group
3853@end smallexample
3854
3855@noindent
3856The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3857value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3858code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3859
b4e9345d
DJ
3860@kindex set backtrace-below-main
3861@kindex show backtrace-below-main
3862
95f90d25
DJ
3863Most programs have a standard entry point---a place where system libraries
3864and startup code transition into user code. For C this is @code{main}.
3865When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace it will terminate
3866the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly system-specific (and generally
3867uninteresting) code. If you need to examine the startup code, then you can
3868change this behavior.
3869
3870@table @code
3871@item set backtrace-below-main off
3872Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
3873default.
3874
3875@item set backtrace-below-main
3876@itemx set backtrace-below-main on
3877Backtraces will continue past the user entry point to the top of the stack.
3878
3879@item show backtrace-below-main
3880Display the current backtrace policy.
3881@end table
3882
6d2ebf8b 3883@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3884@section Selecting a frame
3885
3886Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3887whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3888selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3889of the stack frame just selected.
3890
3891@table @code
d4f3574e 3892@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
41afff9a 3893@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
c906108c
SS
3894@item frame @var{n}
3895@itemx f @var{n}
3896Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3897(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3898innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3899@code{main}.
3900
3901@item frame @var{addr}
3902@itemx f @var{addr}
3903Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3904chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3905impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3906addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3907switches between them.
3908
c906108c
SS
3909On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3910select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3911
3912On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3913pointer and a program counter.
3914
3915On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3916pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3917@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3918@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3919@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3920
3921@kindex up
3922@item up @var{n}
3923Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3924advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3925that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3926
3927@kindex down
41afff9a 3928@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
c906108c
SS
3929@item down @var{n}
3930Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3931advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3932that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3933abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3934@end table
3935
3936All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3937frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3938arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5d161b24 3939frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
c906108c
SS
3940
3941@need 1000
3942For example:
3943
3944@smallexample
3945@group
3946(@value{GDBP}) up
3947#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3948 at env.c:10
394910 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3950@end group
3951@end smallexample
3952
3953After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3954prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
87885426
FN
3955You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
3956editing program by typing @code{edit}.
3957@xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
3958for details.
c906108c
SS
3959
3960@table @code
3961@kindex down-silently
3962@kindex up-silently
3963@item up-silently @var{n}
3964@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3965These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3966respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3967causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3968in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3969distracting.
3970@end table
3971
6d2ebf8b 3972@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
3973@section Information about a frame
3974
3975There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3976stack frame.
3977
3978@table @code
3979@item frame
3980@itemx f
3981When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3982frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3983selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3984argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3985@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3986
3987@kindex info frame
41afff9a 3988@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
c906108c
SS
3989@item info frame
3990@itemx info f
3991This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3992including:
3993
3994@itemize @bullet
5d161b24
DB
3995@item
3996the address of the frame
c906108c
SS
3997@item
3998the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3999@item
4000the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4001@item
4002the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4003@item
4004the address of the frame's arguments
4005@item
d4f3574e
SS
4006the address of the frame's local variables
4007@item
c906108c
SS
4008the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4009@item
4010which registers were saved in the frame
4011@end itemize
4012
4013@noindent The verbose description is useful when
4014something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4015the usual conventions.
4016
4017@item info frame @var{addr}
4018@itemx info f @var{addr}
4019Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4020selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4021command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4022architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4023@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4024
4025@kindex info args
4026@item info args
4027Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4028
4029@item info locals
4030@kindex info locals
4031Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4032line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4033accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4034
c906108c 4035@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
4036@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4037@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
4038@item info catch
4039Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4040current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4041exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4042@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4043@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 4044
c906108c
SS
4045@end table
4046
c906108c 4047
6d2ebf8b 4048@node Source
c906108c
SS
4049@chapter Examining Source Files
4050
4051@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4052information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4053used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4054the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4055(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4056execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4057source files by explicit command.
4058
7a292a7a 4059If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 4060prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 4061@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
4062
4063@menu
4064* List:: Printing source lines
87885426 4065* Edit:: Editing source files
c906108c 4066* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
4067* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4068* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4069@end menu
4070
6d2ebf8b 4071@node List
c906108c
SS
4072@section Printing source lines
4073
4074@kindex list
41afff9a 4075@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
c906108c 4076To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5d161b24 4077(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
c906108c
SS
4078There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4079
4080Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4081
4082@table @code
4083@item list @var{linenum}
4084Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4085current source file.
4086
4087@item list @var{function}
4088Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4089@var{function}.
4090
4091@item list
4092Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4093@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4094printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4095as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4096Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4097
4098@item list -
4099Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4100@end table
4101
4102By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4103the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4104
4105@table @code
4106@kindex set listsize
4107@item set listsize @var{count}
4108Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4109the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4110
4111@kindex show listsize
4112@item show listsize
4113Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4114@end table
4115
4116Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4117so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4118than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4119argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4120each repetition moves up in the source file.
4121
4122@cindex linespec
4123In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4124@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 4125of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
4126Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4127
4128@table @code
4129@item list @var{linespec}
4130Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4131
4132@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4133Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4134linespecs.
4135
4136@item list ,@var{last}
4137Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4138
4139@item list @var{first},
4140Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4141
4142@item list +
4143Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4144
4145@item list -
4146Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4147
4148@item list
4149As described in the preceding table.
4150@end table
4151
4152Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4153kinds of linespec.
4154
4155@table @code
4156@item @var{number}
4157Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4158When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4159the same source file as the first linespec.
4160
4161@item +@var{offset}
4162Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4163When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4164two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4165first linespec.
4166
4167@item -@var{offset}
4168Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4169
4170@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4171Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4172
4173@item @var{function}
4174Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4175For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4176
4177@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4178Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4179function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4180file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4181identically named functions in different source files.
4182
4183@item *@var{address}
4184Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4185@var{address} may be any expression.
4186@end table
4187
87885426
FN
4188@node Edit
4189@section Editing source files
4190@cindex editing source files
4191
4192@kindex edit
4193@kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4194To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4195The editing program of your choice
4196is invoked with the current line set to
4197the active line in the program.
4198Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4199want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4200
4201Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4202
4203@table @code
4204@item edit
4205Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4206
4207@item edit @var{number}
4208Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4209
4210@item edit @var{function}
4211Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4212
4213@item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4214Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4215
4216@item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4217Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4218function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4219file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4220identically named functions in different source files.
4221
4222@item edit *@var{address}
4223Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4224@var{address} may be any expression.
4225@end table
4226
4227@subsection Choosing your editor
4228You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
4229@footnote{
4230The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
4231following command-line syntax:
10998722 4232@smallexample
87885426 4233ex +@var{number} file
10998722
AC
4234@end smallexample
4235The optional numeric value +@var{number} designates the active line in
4236the file.}. By default, it is @value{EDITOR}, but you can change this
4237by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
4238@value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
4239@code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
4240@smallexample
87885426
FN
4241EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
4242export EDITOR
4243gdb ...
10998722 4244@end smallexample
87885426 4245or in the @code{csh} shell,
10998722 4246@smallexample
87885426
FN
4247setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
4248gdb ...
10998722 4249@end smallexample
87885426 4250
6d2ebf8b 4251@node Search
c906108c
SS
4252@section Searching source files
4253@cindex searching
4254@kindex reverse-search
4255
4256There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4257regular expression.
4258
4259@table @code
4260@kindex search
4261@kindex forward-search
4262@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4263@itemx search @var{regexp}
4264The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4265starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5d161b24 4266@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
c906108c
SS
4267synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4268@code{fo}.
4269
4270@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4271The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4272with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4273for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4274this command as @code{rev}.
4275@end table
c906108c 4276
6d2ebf8b 4277@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4278@section Specifying source directories
4279
4280@cindex source path
4281@cindex directories for source files
4282Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4283files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4284the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4285session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4286this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4287it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4288in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4289the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4290the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4291path.
4292
4293If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4294object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4295too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4296compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4297last resort.
4298
4299Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4300any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4301each line is in the file.
4302
4303@kindex directory
4304@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4305When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4306and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4307To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4308
4309@table @code
4310@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4311@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4312Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4313directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4314(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4315part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4316whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4317path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4318
4319@kindex cdir
4320@kindex cwd
41afff9a
EZ
4321@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4322@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
4323@cindex compilation directory
4324@cindex current directory
4325@cindex working directory
4326@cindex directory, current
4327@cindex directory, compilation
4328You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4329directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4330working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4331tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4332session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4333directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4334
4335@item directory
4336Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4337
4338@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4339@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4340
4341@item show directories
4342@kindex show directories
4343Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4344@end table
4345
4346If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4347interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4348versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4349
4350@enumerate
4351@item
4352Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4353
4354@item
4355Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4356directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4357directories in one command.
4358@end enumerate
4359
6d2ebf8b 4360@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4361@section Source and machine code
4362
4363You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4364addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4365a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4366mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5d161b24 4367line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
c906108c
SS
4368well as hex.
4369
4370@table @code
4371@kindex info line
4372@item info line @var{linespec}
4373Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4374source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4375the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4376source lines}).
4377@end table
4378
4379For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4380the object code for the first line of function
4381@code{m4_changequote}:
4382
d4f3574e
SS
4383@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4384@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4385@smallexample
96a2c332 4386(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4387Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4388@end smallexample
4389
4390@noindent
4391We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4392@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4393@smallexample
4394(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4395Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4396@end smallexample
4397
4398@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
41afff9a 4399@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
c906108c
SS
4400After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4401is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4402sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4403,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4404convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4405variables}).
4406
4407@table @code
4408@kindex disassemble
4409@cindex assembly instructions
4410@cindex instructions, assembly
4411@cindex machine instructions
4412@cindex listing machine instructions
4413@item disassemble
4414This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4415instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4416program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4417command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4418surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4419(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4420@end table
4421
c906108c
SS
4422The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4423HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4424
4425@smallexample
4426(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4427Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
44280x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
44290x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
44300x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
44310x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
44320x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
44330x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
44340x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
44350x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4436End of assembler dump.
4437@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4438
4439Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4440mnemonics or other syntax.
4441
4442@table @code
d4f3574e 4443@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4444@cindex assembly instructions
4445@cindex instructions, assembly
4446@cindex machine instructions
4447@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4448@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4449@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4450@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4451Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4452program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4453
4454Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4455can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4456The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4457assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4458@end table
4459
4460
6d2ebf8b 4461@node Data
c906108c
SS
4462@chapter Examining Data
4463
4464@cindex printing data
4465@cindex examining data
4466@kindex print
4467@kindex inspect
4468@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4469@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4470@c different window or something like that.
4471The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4472command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4473evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4474program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4475Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4476
4477@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4478@item print @var{expr}
4479@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4480@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4481value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4482you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4483@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4484formats}.
4485
4486@item print
4487@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4488If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4489@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4490conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4491@end table
4492
4493A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4494It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4495specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4496
7a292a7a 4497If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4498fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4499command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4500Table}.
c906108c
SS
4501
4502@menu
4503* Expressions:: Expressions
4504* Variables:: Program variables
4505* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4506* Output Formats:: Output formats
4507* Memory:: Examining memory
4508* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4509* Print Settings:: Print settings
4510* Value History:: Value history
4511* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4512* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4513* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
53c69bd7 4514* Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
29e57380 4515* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
16d9dec6 4516* Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
a0eb71c5
KB
4517* Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
4518 character set than GDB does
c906108c
SS
4519@end menu
4520
6d2ebf8b 4521@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4522@section Expressions
4523
4524@cindex expressions
4525@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4526compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4527by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
e2e0bcd1
JB
4528@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
4529casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
4530you compiled your program to include this information; see
4531@ref{Compilation}.
c906108c 4532
d4f3574e
SS
4533@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4534the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5d161b24 4535you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
d4f3574e 4536memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4537
c906108c
SS
4538Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4539this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4540Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4541languages.
4542
4543In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4544expressions regardless of your programming language.
4545
4546Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4547useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4548at that address in memory.
4549@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4550
4551@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4552to programming languages:
4553
4554@table @code
4555@item @@
4556@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4557@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4558
4559@item ::
4560@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4561function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4562
4563@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4564@cindex type casting memory
4565@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4566@cindex casts, to view memory
4567@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4568Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4569memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4570pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4571a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4572normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4573@end table
4574
6d2ebf8b 4575@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4576@section Program variables
4577
4578The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4579in your program.
4580
4581Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4582(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4583
4584@itemize @bullet
4585@item
4586global (or file-static)
4587@end itemize
4588
5d161b24 4589@noindent or
c906108c
SS
4590
4591@itemize @bullet
4592@item
4593visible according to the scope rules of the
4594programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5d161b24 4595@end itemize
c906108c
SS
4596
4597@noindent This means that in the function
4598
474c8240 4599@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4600foo (a)
4601 int a;
4602@{
4603 bar (a);
4604 @{
4605 int b = test ();
4606 bar (b);
4607 @}
4608@}
474c8240 4609@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4610
4611@noindent
4612you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4613executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4614examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4615the block where @code{b} is declared.
4616
4617@cindex variable name conflict
4618There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4619scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4620in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4621function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4622happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4623you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4624using the colon-colon notation:
4625
d4f3574e 4626@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4627@iftex
4628@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
41afff9a 4629@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
c906108c 4630@end iftex
474c8240 4631@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4632@var{file}::@var{variable}
4633@var{function}::@var{variable}
474c8240 4634@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4635
4636@noindent
4637Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4638static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4639make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4640to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4641
474c8240 4642@smallexample
c906108c 4643(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
474c8240 4644@end smallexample
c906108c 4645
b37052ae 4646@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
c906108c 4647This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
b37052ae 4648use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
4649scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4650@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4651@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4652
4653@cindex wrong values
4654@cindex variable values, wrong
4655@quotation
4656@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4657wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4658scope, and just before exit.
4659@end quotation
4660You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4661This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4662set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4663stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4664values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4665also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4666after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4667variable definitions may be gone.
4668
4669This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4670To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4671when compiling.
4672
d4f3574e
SS
4673@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4674Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4675unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4676opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4677offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4678might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4679happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4680
474c8240 4681@smallexample
d4f3574e 4682No symbol "foo" in current context.
474c8240 4683@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
4684
4685To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4686different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
b37052ae 4687formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler usually
d4f3574e
SS
4688supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4689in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
96c405b3 4690to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
d4f3574e
SS
4691debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4692Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4693information.
4694
4695
6d2ebf8b 4696@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4697@section Artificial arrays
4698
4699@cindex artificial array
41afff9a 4700@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
c906108c
SS
4701It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4702same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4703dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4704program.
4705
4706You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4707@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4708operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4709and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4710of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4711the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4712argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4713following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4714example. If a program says
4715
474c8240 4716@smallexample
c906108c 4717int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
474c8240 4718@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4719
4720@noindent
4721you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4722
474c8240 4723@smallexample
c906108c 4724p *array@@len
474c8240 4725@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4726
4727The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4728with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4729subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4730Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4731(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4732
4733Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4734This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4735The value need not be in memory:
474c8240 4736@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4737(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4738$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
474c8240 4739@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4740
4741As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4742@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c 4743the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
474c8240 4744@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4745(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4746$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
474c8240 4747@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4748
4749Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4750moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4751actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4752of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4753to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4754variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4755interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4756instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4757structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4758in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4759
474c8240 4760@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4761set $i = 0
4762p dtab[$i++]->fv
4763@key{RET}
4764@key{RET}
4765@dots{}
474c8240 4766@end smallexample
c906108c 4767
6d2ebf8b 4768@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4769@section Output formats
4770
4771@cindex formatted output
4772@cindex output formats
4773By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4774this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4775in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4776at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4777these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4778
4779The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4780already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4781@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4782letters supported are:
4783
4784@table @code
4785@item x
4786Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4787hexadecimal.
4788
4789@item d
4790Print as integer in signed decimal.
4791
4792@item u
4793Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4794
4795@item o
4796Print as integer in octal.
4797
4798@item t
4799Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4800@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4801used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4802see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4803
4804@item a
4805@cindex unknown address, locating
3d67e040 4806@cindex locate address
c906108c
SS
4807Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4808the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4809where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4810
474c8240 4811@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4812(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4813$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
474c8240 4814@end smallexample
c906108c 4815
3d67e040
EZ
4816@noindent
4817The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4818@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4819
c906108c
SS
4820@item c
4821Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4822
4823@item f
4824Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4825using typical floating point syntax.
4826@end table
4827
4828For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4829
474c8240 4830@smallexample
c906108c 4831p/x $pc
474c8240 4832@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4833
4834@noindent
4835Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4836names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4837
4838To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4839you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4840expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4841
6d2ebf8b 4842@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4843@section Examining memory
4844
4845You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4846any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4847
4848@cindex examining memory
4849@table @code
41afff9a 4850@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
c906108c
SS
4851@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4852@itemx x @var{addr}
4853@itemx x
4854Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4855@end table
4856
4857@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4858much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4859expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4860If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4861Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4862
4863@table @r
4864@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4865The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4866how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4867@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4868@c 4.1.2.
4869
4870@item @var{f}, the display format
4871The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4872@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4873The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4874The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4875
4876@item @var{u}, the unit size
4877The unit size is any of
4878
4879@table @code
4880@item b
4881Bytes.
4882@item h
4883Halfwords (two bytes).
4884@item w
4885Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4886@item g
4887Giant words (eight bytes).
4888@end table
4889
4890Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4891default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4892@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4893
4894@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4895@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4896memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4897it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4898@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4899@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4900other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4901the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4902starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4903a value from memory).
4904@end table
4905
4906For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4907(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4908starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4909words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4910@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4911
4912Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4913letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4914unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4915specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4916(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4917
4918Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4919and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4920@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4921including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4922alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4923Code,,Source and machine code}.
4924
4925All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4926easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4927you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4928instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4929with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4930the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4931for successive uses of @code{x}.
4932
4933@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4934The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4935in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4936would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4937subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4938@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4939examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4940@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4941the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4942
4943If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4944are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4945address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4946
6d2ebf8b 4947@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4948@section Automatic display
4949@cindex automatic display
4950@cindex display of expressions
4951
4952If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4953(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4954display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4955Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4956to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4957The automatic display looks like this:
4958
474c8240 4959@smallexample
c906108c
SS
49602: foo = 38
49613: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
474c8240 4962@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4963
4964@noindent
4965This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4966displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4967specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4968whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4969format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4970or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4971supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4972
4973@table @code
4974@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
4975@item display @var{expr}
4976Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
4977each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4978
4979@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4980
d4f3574e 4981@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 4982For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 4983count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
4984arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4985@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4986
4987@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4988For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4989number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4990be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4991doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4992@end table
4993
4994For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4995instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 4996is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
4997
4998@table @code
4999@kindex delete display
5000@kindex undisplay
5001@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5002@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5003Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5004
5005@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5006(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5007
5008@kindex disable display
5009@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5010Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5011item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5012enabled again later.
5013
5014@kindex enable display
5015@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5016Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5017again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5018
5019@item display
5020Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5021done when your program stops.
5022
5023@kindex info display
5024@item info display
5025Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5026automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5027values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5028It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5029because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5030@end table
5031
5032If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5033sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5034expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5035variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5036@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5037@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5038continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5039there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5040automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5041is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5042
6d2ebf8b 5043@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
5044@section Print settings
5045
5046@cindex format options
5047@cindex print settings
5048@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5049and symbols are printed.
5050
5051@noindent
5052These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5053
5054@table @code
5055@kindex set print address
5056@item set print address
5057@itemx set print address on
5058@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5059traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5060even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5061is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5062@code{set print address on}:
5063
5064@smallexample
5065@group
5066(@value{GDBP}) f
5067#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5068 at input.c:530
5069530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5070@end group
5071@end smallexample
5072
5073@item set print address off
5074Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5075this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
5076
5077@smallexample
5078@group
5079(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
5080(@value{GDBP}) f
5081#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
5082530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5083@end group
5084@end smallexample
5085
5086You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
5087dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
5088@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
5089all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
5090
5091@kindex show print address
5092@item show print address
5093Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
5094@end table
5095
5096When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
5097closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
5098identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
5099source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
5100@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
5101you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
5102it prints a symbolic address:
5103
5104@table @code
5105@kindex set print symbol-filename
5106@item set print symbol-filename on
5107Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
5108symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5109
5110@item set print symbol-filename off
5111Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5112default.
5113
5114@kindex show print symbol-filename
5115@item show print symbol-filename
5116Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5117line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5118@end table
5119
5120Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5121numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5122number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5123
5124Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5125printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5126
5127@table @code
5128@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
5129@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5130Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5131offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5d161b24 5132@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
5133to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5134
5135@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
5136@item show print max-symbolic-offset
5137Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5138symbolic address.
5139@end table
5140
5141@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5142@cindex pointer, finding referent
5143If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5144@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5145and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5146@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5147For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5148at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5149
474c8240 5150@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5151(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5152(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5153$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
474c8240 5154@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5155
5156@quotation
5157@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5158does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5159the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5160@end quotation
5161
5162Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5163
5164@table @code
5165@kindex set print array
5166@item set print array
5167@itemx set print array on
5168Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5169but uses more space. The default is off.
5170
5171@item set print array off
5172Return to compressed format for arrays.
5173
5174@kindex show print array
5175@item show print array
5176Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5177arrays.
5178
5179@kindex set print elements
5180@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5181Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5182If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5183printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5184This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 5185When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
5186Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5187
5188@kindex show print elements
5189@item show print elements
5190Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5191If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5192
5193@kindex set print null-stop
5194@item set print null-stop
5195Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 5196@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 5197contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 5198The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5199
5200@kindex set print pretty
5201@item set print pretty on
5d161b24 5202Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
c906108c
SS
5203per line, like this:
5204
5205@smallexample
5206@group
5207$1 = @{
5208 next = 0x0,
5209 flags = @{
5210 sweet = 1,
5211 sour = 1
5212 @},
5213 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5214@}
5215@end group
5216@end smallexample
5217
5218@item set print pretty off
5219Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5220
5221@smallexample
5222@group
5223$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5224meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5225@end group
5226@end smallexample
5227
5228@noindent
5229This is the default format.
5230
5231@kindex show print pretty
5232@item show print pretty
5233Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5234
5235@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5236@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5237Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5238@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5239character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5240best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5241high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5242
5243@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5244Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5245international character sets, and is the default.
5246
5247@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5248@item show print sevenbit-strings
5249Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5250
5251@kindex set print union
5252@item set print union on
5d161b24 5253Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
c906108c
SS
5254is the default setting.
5255
5256@item set print union off
5257Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5258
5259@kindex show print union
5260@item show print union
5261Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5262structures.
5263
5264For example, given the declarations
5265
5266@smallexample
5267typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5268typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5d161b24 5269typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
c906108c
SS
5270 Bug_forms;
5271
5272struct thing @{
5273 Species it;
5274 union @{
5275 Tree_forms tree;
5276 Bug_forms bug;
5277 @} form;
5278@};
5279
5280struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5281@end smallexample
5282
5283@noindent
5284with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5285
5286@smallexample
5287$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5288@end smallexample
5289
5290@noindent
5291and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5292
5293@smallexample
5294$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5295@end smallexample
5296@end table
5297
c906108c
SS
5298@need 1000
5299@noindent
b37052ae 5300These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
c906108c
SS
5301
5302@table @code
5303@cindex demangling
5304@kindex set print demangle
5305@item set print demangle
5306@itemx set print demangle on
b37052ae 5307Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
c906108c 5308(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5309linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5310
5311@kindex show print demangle
5312@item show print demangle
b37052ae 5313Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
c906108c
SS
5314
5315@kindex set print asm-demangle
5316@item set print asm-demangle
5317@itemx set print asm-demangle on
b37052ae 5318Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
c906108c
SS
5319in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5320The default is off.
5321
5322@kindex show print asm-demangle
5323@item show print asm-demangle
b37052ae 5324Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
c906108c
SS
5325or demangled form.
5326
5327@kindex set demangle-style
b37052ae
EZ
5328@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5329@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
5330@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5331Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
b37052ae 5332represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
c906108c
SS
5333
5334@table @code
5335@item auto
5336Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5337
5338@item gnu
b37052ae 5339Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5340This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5341
5342@item hp
b37052ae 5343Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5344
5345@item lucid
b37052ae 5346Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5347
5348@item arm
b37052ae 5349Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
c906108c
SS
5350@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5351debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5352require further enhancement to permit that.
5353
5354@end table
5355If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5356
5357@kindex show demangle-style
5358@item show demangle-style
b37052ae 5359Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
c906108c
SS
5360
5361@kindex set print object
5362@item set print object
5363@itemx set print object on
5364When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5365(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5366the virtual function table.
5367
5368@item set print object off
5369Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5370virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5371
5372@kindex show print object
5373@item show print object
5374Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5375
5376@kindex set print static-members
5377@item set print static-members
5378@itemx set print static-members on
b37052ae 5379Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5380
5381@item set print static-members off
b37052ae 5382Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
c906108c
SS
5383
5384@kindex show print static-members
5385@item show print static-members
b37052ae 5386Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
c906108c
SS
5387
5388@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5389@kindex set print vtbl
5390@item set print vtbl
5391@itemx set print vtbl on
b37052ae 5392Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c 5393(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 5394ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5395
5396@item set print vtbl off
b37052ae 5397Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
c906108c
SS
5398
5399@kindex show print vtbl
5400@item show print vtbl
b37052ae 5401Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
c906108c 5402@end table
c906108c 5403
6d2ebf8b 5404@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5405@section Value history
5406
5407@cindex value history
5d161b24
DB
5408Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5409@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5410Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5411(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5412When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5413since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
c906108c
SS
5414symbol table.
5415
5416@cindex @code{$}
5417@cindex @code{$$}
5418@cindex history number
5419The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5420refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5421@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5422printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5423history number.
5424
5425To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5426history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5427remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5428the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5429@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5430is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5431@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5432
5433For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5434want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5435
474c8240 5436@smallexample
c906108c 5437p *$
474c8240 5438@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5439
5440If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5441to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5442
474c8240 5443@smallexample
c906108c 5444p *$.next
474c8240 5445@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5446
5447@noindent
5448You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5449command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5450
5451Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5452@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5453
474c8240 5454@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5455print x
5456set x=5
474c8240 5457@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5458
5459@noindent
5460then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5461remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5462
5463@table @code
5464@kindex show values
5465@item show values
5466Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5467This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5468values} does not change the history.
5469
5470@item show values @var{n}
5471Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5472
5473@item show values +
5474Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5475values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5476@end table
5477
5478Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5479same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5480
6d2ebf8b 5481@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5482@section Convenience variables
5483
5484@cindex convenience variables
5485@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5486@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5487exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5488setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5489of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5490
5491Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5492@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5493the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5494(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5495by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5496
5497You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5498expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5499For example:
5500
474c8240 5501@smallexample
c906108c 5502set $foo = *object_ptr
474c8240 5503@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5504
5505@noindent
5506would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5507@code{object_ptr}.
5508
5509Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5510value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5511value with another assignment at any time.
5512
5513Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5514variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5515that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5516variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5517
5518@table @code
5519@kindex show convenience
5520@item show convenience
5521Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5522Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5523@end table
5524
5525One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5526incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5527a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5528
474c8240 5529@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5530set $i = 0
5531print bar[$i++]->contents
474c8240 5532@end smallexample
c906108c 5533
d4f3574e
SS
5534@noindent
5535Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5536
5537Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5538values likely to be useful.
5539
5540@table @code
41afff9a 5541@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5542@item $_
5543The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5544the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5545commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5546set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5547and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5548except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5549to the type of @code{$__}.
5550
41afff9a 5551@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5552@item $__
5553The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5554to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5555to match the format in which the data was printed.
5556
5557@item $_exitcode
41afff9a 5558@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5559The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5560the program being debugged terminates.
5561@end table
5562
53a5351d
JM
5563On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5564begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5565name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5566
6d2ebf8b 5567@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5568@section Registers
5569
5570@cindex registers
5571You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5572with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5573for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5574your machine.
5575
5576@table @code
5577@kindex info registers
5578@item info registers
5579Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
c85508ee 5580and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
c906108c
SS
5581
5582@kindex info all-registers
5583@cindex floating point registers
5584@item info all-registers
5585Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
c85508ee 5586and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
c906108c
SS
5587
5588@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5589Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5d161b24
DB
5590As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5591the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
c906108c
SS
5592the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5593@end table
5594
5595@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5596expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5597architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5598@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5599the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5600pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5601register that contains the processor status. For example,
5602you could print the program counter in hex with
5603
474c8240 5604@smallexample
c906108c 5605p/x $pc
474c8240 5606@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5607
5608@noindent
5609or print the instruction to be executed next with
5610
474c8240 5611@smallexample
c906108c 5612x/i $pc
474c8240 5613@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5614
5615@noindent
5616or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5617one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5618memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5619stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5620stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5621regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5622see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c 5623
474c8240 5624@smallexample
c906108c 5625set $sp += 4
474c8240 5626@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5627
5628Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5629your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5630so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5631shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5632registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5633can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5634is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5635
5636@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5637integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5638special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5639registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5640to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5641(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5642@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5643
5644Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5645means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5646the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5647sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5648coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5649programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5d161b24 5650cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
c906108c
SS
5651that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5652prints the data in both formats.
5653
5654Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5655(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5656value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5657were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5658true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5659frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5660
5661However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5662code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5663@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5664frame makes no difference.
5665
6d2ebf8b 5666@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5667@section Floating point hardware
5668@cindex floating point
5669
5670Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5671you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5672
5673@table @code
5674@kindex info float
5675@item info float
5676Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5677point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5678floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5679the ARM and x86 machines.
5680@end table
c906108c 5681
e76f1f2e
AC
5682@node Vector Unit
5683@section Vector Unit
5684@cindex vector unit
5685
5686Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
5687more information about the status of the vector unit.
5688
5689@table @code
5690@kindex info vector
5691@item info vector
5692Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
5693layout vary depending on the hardware.
5694@end table
5695
29e57380 5696@node Memory Region Attributes
16d9dec6 5697@section Memory region attributes
29e57380
C
5698@cindex memory region attributes
5699
5700@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5701required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5702to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5703use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5704
5705Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5706memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5707accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5708been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5709all memory.
5710
5711When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5712to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5713
5714@table @code
5715@kindex mem
bfac230e
DH
5716@item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5717Define memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
5718attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a
5719special case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
5720(0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
29e57380
C
5721
5722@kindex delete mem
5723@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5724Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5725
5726@kindex disable mem
5727@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5728Disable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5729A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5730It may be enabled again later.
5731
5732@kindex enable mem
5733@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5734Enable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5735
5736@kindex info mem
5737@item info mem
5738Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5739for each region.
5740
5741@table @emph
5742@item Memory Region Number
5743@item Enabled or Disabled.
5744Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5745Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5746
5747@item Lo Address
5748The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5749
5750@item Hi Address
5751The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5752
5753@item Attributes
5754The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5755@end table
5756@end table
5757
5758
5759@subsection Attributes
5760
5761@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5762The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5763write accesses to a memory region.
5764
5765While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5766memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5767etc. from accessing memory.
5768
5769@table @code
5770@item ro
5771Memory is read only.
5772@item wo
5773Memory is write only.
5774@item rw
6ca652b0 5775Memory is read/write. This is the default.
29e57380
C
5776@end table
5777
5778@subsubsection Memory Access Size
5779The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5780accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5781require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5782specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5783
5784@table @code
5785@item 8
5786Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5787@item 16
5788Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5789@item 32
5790Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5791@item 64
5792Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5793@end table
5794
5795@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5796@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5797@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5798@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5799@c
5800@c @table @code
5801@c @item hwbreak
5802@c Always use hardware breakpoints
5803@c @item swbreak (default)
5804@c @end table
5805
5806@subsubsection Data Cache
5807The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5808memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5809protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5810does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5811registers.
5812
5813@table @code
5814@item cache
5815Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6ca652b0
EZ
5816@item nocache
5817Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
29e57380
C
5818@end table
5819
5820@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5821@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5822@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5823@c
5824@c @table @code
5825@c @item verify
5826@c @item noverify (default)
5827@c @end table
5828
16d9dec6
MS
5829@node Dump/Restore Files
5830@section Copy between memory and a file
5831@cindex dump/restore files
5832@cindex append data to a file
5833@cindex dump data to a file
5834@cindex restore data from a file
5835@kindex dump
5836@kindex append
5837@kindex restore
5838
5839The commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and @code{restore} are used
5840for copying data between target memory and a file. Data is written
5841into a file using @code{dump} or @code{append}, and restored from a
5842file into memory by using @code{restore}. Files may be binary, srec,
5843intel hex, or tekhex (but only binary files can be appended).
5844
5845@table @code
5846@kindex dump binary
5847@kindex append binary
5848@item dump binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5849Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5850raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5851
5852@item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5853Append contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} to
5854raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5855
5856@item dump binary value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5857Dump value of @var{expression} into raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5858
5859@item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{expression}
5860Append value of @var{expression} to raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5861
5862@kindex dump ihex
5863@item dump ihex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5864Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5865intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5866
5867@item dump ihex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5868Dump value of @var{expression} into intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5869
5870@kindex dump srec
5871@item dump srec memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5872Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5873srec format file @var{filename}.
5874
5875@item dump srec value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5876Dump value of @var{expression} into srec format file @var{filename}.
5877
5878@kindex dump tekhex
5879@item dump tekhex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5880Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5881tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5882
5883@item dump tekhex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5884Dump value of @var{expression} into tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5885
42f9b0a5 5886@item restore @var{filename} [@var{binary}] @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
16d9dec6
MS
5887Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The @code{restore}
5888command can automatically recognize any known bfd file format, except for
5889raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you must use the optional argument
5890@var{binary} after the filename.
5891
5892If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
5893contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
5894they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
5895a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
5896from that location.
5897
5898If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
5899file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
5900These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
5901the @var{bias} argument is applied.
5902
5903@end table
5904
a0eb71c5
KB
5905@node Character Sets
5906@section Character Sets
5907@cindex character sets
5908@cindex charset
5909@cindex translating between character sets
5910@cindex host character set
5911@cindex target character set
5912
5913If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
5914represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
5915@value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
5916you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
5917character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
5918@dfn{target character set}.
5919
5920For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
5921uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
5922remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
5923running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
5924then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
5925@sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
5926target-charset ebcdic-us}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
5927@sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
5928character and string literals in expressions.
5929
5930@value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
5931the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
5932target-charset} command, described below.
5933
5934Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
5935support:
5936
5937@table @code
5938@item set target-charset @var{charset}
5939@kindex set target-charset
5940Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
5941character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you invoke the
5942@code{set target-charset} command with no argument, @value{GDBN} lists
5943the character sets it supports.
5944@end table
5945
5946@table @code
5947@item set host-charset @var{charset}
5948@kindex set host-charset
5949Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
5950
5951By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
5952system it is running on; you can override that default using the
5953@code{set host-charset} command.
5954
5955@value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
5956set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
5957indicate which can be host character sets, but if you invoke the
5958@code{set host-charset} command with no argument, @value{GDBN} lists the
5959character sets it supports, placing an asterisk (@samp{*}) after those
5960it can use as a host character set.
5961
5962@item set charset @var{charset}
5963@kindex set charset
5964Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. If you
5965invoke the @code{set charset} command with no argument, it lists the
5966character sets it supports. @value{GDBN} can only use certain character
5967sets as its host character set; it marks those in the list with an
5968asterisk (@samp{*}).
5969
5970@item show charset
5971@itemx show host-charset
5972@itemx show target-charset
5973@kindex show charset
5974@kindex show host-charset
5975@kindex show target-charset
5976Show the current host and target charsets. The @code{show host-charset}
5977and @code{show target-charset} commands are synonyms for @code{show
5978charset}.
5979
5980@end table
5981
5982@value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
5983sets:
5984
5985@table @code
5986
5987@item ASCII
5988@cindex ASCII character set
5989Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
5990character set.
5991
5992@item ISO-8859-1
5993@cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
5994@cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
5995The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends ASCII with accented
5996characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
5997this as its host character set.
5998
5999@item EBCDIC-US
6000@itemx IBM1047
6001@cindex EBCDIC character set
6002@cindex IBM1047 character set
6003Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
6004mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
6005@value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
6006
6007@end table
6008
6009Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
6010GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
6011encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
6012
6013Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
6014Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
6015@file{charset-test.c}:
6016
6017@smallexample
6018#include <stdio.h>
6019
6020char ascii_hello[]
6021 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
6022 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
6023char ibm1047_hello[]
6024 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
6025 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
6026
6027main ()
6028@{
6029 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6030@}
10998722 6031@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6032
6033In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
6034containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
6035encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
6036
6037We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
6038
6039@smallexample
6040$ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
6041$ gdb -nw charset-test
6042GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
6043Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6044@dots{}
6045(gdb)
10998722 6046@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6047
6048We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
6049@value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
6050strings:
6051
6052@smallexample
6053(gdb) show charset
6054The current host and target character set is `iso-8859-1'.
6055(gdb)
10998722 6056@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6057
6058For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
6059initial character set:
6060@smallexample
6061(gdb) set charset ascii
6062(gdb) show charset
6063The current host and target character set is `ascii'.
6064(gdb)
10998722 6065@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6066
6067Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
6068host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
6069characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
6070them properly. Since our current target character set is also
6071@sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
6072
6073@smallexample
6074(gdb) print ascii_hello
6075$1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
6076(gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6077$2 = 72 'H'
6078(gdb)
10998722 6079@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6080
6081@value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
6082literals you use in expressions:
6083
6084@smallexample
6085(gdb) print '+'
6086$3 = 43 '+'
6087(gdb)
10998722 6088@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6089
6090The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
6091character.
6092
6093@value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
6094target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
6095character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
6096
6097@smallexample
6098(gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6099$4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
6100(gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6101$5 = 200 '\310'
6102(gdb)
10998722 6103@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6104
6105If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} command without an argument,
6106@value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
6107
6108@smallexample
6109(gdb) set target-charset
6110Valid character sets are:
6111 ascii *
6112 iso-8859-1 *
6113 ebcdic-us
6114 ibm1047
6115* - can be used as a host character set
10998722 6116@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6117
6118We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
6119program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
6120@value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
6121target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
6122@sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
6123
6124@smallexample
6125(gdb) set target-charset ibm1047
6126(gdb) show charset
6127The current host character set is `ascii'.
6128The current target character set is `ibm1047'.
6129(gdb) print ascii_hello
6130$6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
6131(gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6132$7 = 72 '\110'
6133(gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6134$8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
6135(gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6136$9 = 200 'H'
6137(gdb)
10998722 6138@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6139
6140As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
6141string literals you use in expressions:
6142
6143@smallexample
6144(gdb) print '+'
6145$10 = 78 '+'
6146(gdb)
10998722 6147@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6148
6149The IBM1047 character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
6150character.
6151
6152
e2e0bcd1
JB
6153@node Macros
6154@chapter C Preprocessor Macros
6155
6156Some languages, such as C and C++, provide a way to define and invoke
6157``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
6158@value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
6159the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
6160where it was defined.
6161
6162You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
6163with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
6164include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
6165with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
6166
6167A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
6168and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
6169points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
6170no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
6171uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
6172@value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
6173see @ref{List}.
6174
6175At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
6176token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
6177variable-arity macros.
6178
6179Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
6180macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
6181the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
6182
6183@table @code
6184
6185@kindex macro expand
6186@cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
6187@cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
6188@cindex expanding preprocessor macros
6189@item macro expand @var{expression}
6190@itemx macro exp @var{expression}
6191Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
6192@var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
6193not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
6194it can be any string of tokens.
6195
6196@kindex macro expand-once
6197@item macro expand-once @var{expression}
6198@itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
6199@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
6200expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
6201@var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
6202left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
6203particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
6204expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
6205parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
6206can be any string of tokens.
6207
475b0867 6208@kindex info macro
e2e0bcd1
JB
6209@cindex macro definition, showing
6210@cindex definition, showing a macro's
475b0867 6211@item info macro @var{macro}
e2e0bcd1
JB
6212Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
6213source location where that definition was established.
6214
6215@kindex macro define
6216@cindex user-defined macros
6217@cindex defining macros interactively
6218@cindex macros, user-defined
6219@item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
6220@itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
6221@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
6222preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
6223by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
6224command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
6225second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
6226given in @var{arglist}.
6227
6228A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
6229evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
6230undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
6231definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
6232well as any previous user-supplied definition.
6233
6234@kindex macro undef
6235@item macro undef @var{macro}
6236@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
6237definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
6238definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
6239above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
6240debugged.
6241
6242@end table
6243
6244@cindex macros, example of debugging with
6245Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
6246show our source files:
6247
6248@smallexample
6249$ cat sample.c
6250#include <stdio.h>
6251#include "sample.h"
6252
6253#define M 42
6254#define ADD(x) (M + x)
6255
6256main ()
6257@{
6258#define N 28
6259 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6260#undef N
6261 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6262#define N 1729
6263 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
6264@}
6265$ cat sample.h
6266#define Q <
6267$
6268@end smallexample
6269
6270Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
6271We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
6272compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
6273information.
6274
6275@smallexample
6276$ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
6277$
6278@end smallexample
6279
6280Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
6281
6282@smallexample
6283$ gdb -nw sample
6284GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
6285Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6286GDB is free software, @dots{}
6287(gdb)
6288@end smallexample
6289
6290We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
6291program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
6292to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
6293
6294@smallexample
6295(gdb) list main
62963
62974 #define M 42
62985 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
62996
63007 main ()
63018 @{
63029 #define N 28
630310 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
630411 #undef N
630512 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
475b0867 6306(gdb) info macro ADD
e2e0bcd1
JB
6307Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
6308#define ADD(x) (M + x)
475b0867 6309(gdb) info macro Q
e2e0bcd1
JB
6310Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
6311 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
6312#define Q <
6313(gdb) macro expand ADD(1)
6314expands to: (42 + 1)
6315(gdb) macro expand-once ADD(1)
6316expands to: once (M + 1)
6317(gdb)
6318@end smallexample
6319
6320In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
6321the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
6322@code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
6323which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
6324
6325Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
6326the source line of the current stack frame:
6327
6328@smallexample
6329(gdb) break main
6330Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
6331(gdb) run
6332Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
6333
6334Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
633510 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6336(gdb)
6337@end smallexample
6338
6339At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
6340
6341@smallexample
475b0867 6342(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6343Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
6344#define N 28
6345(gdb) macro expand N Q M
6346expands to: 28 < 42
6347(gdb) print N Q M
6348$1 = 1
6349(gdb)
6350@end smallexample
6351
6352As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
6353give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
6354thereof) in force at each point:
6355
6356@smallexample
6357(gdb) next
6358Hello, world!
635912 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
475b0867 6360(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6361The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
6362at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
6363(gdb) next
6364We're so creative.
636514 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
475b0867 6366(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6367Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
6368#define N 1729
6369(gdb) macro expand N Q M
6370expands to: 1729 < 42
6371(gdb) print N Q M
6372$2 = 0
6373(gdb)
6374@end smallexample
6375
6376
b37052ae
EZ
6377@node Tracepoints
6378@chapter Tracepoints
6379@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
6380@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
6381
6382@cindex tracepoints
6383In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
6384the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
6385anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
6386depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
6387might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
6388fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
6389to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
6390
6391Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
6392specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
6393arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
6394Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
6395those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
6396expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
6397for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
6398a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
6399in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
6400values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
6401unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
6402
6403The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
2c0069bb
EZ
6404targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know how
6405to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the remote
6406stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} support
6407tracepoints as of this writing.
b37052ae
EZ
6408
6409This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
6410
6411@menu
6412* Set Tracepoints::
6413* Analyze Collected Data::
6414* Tracepoint Variables::
6415@end menu
6416
6417@node Set Tracepoints
6418@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
6419
6420Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
6421tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
6422tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
6423breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
6424one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
6425tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
6426work on.
6427
6428For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
6429of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
6430it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
6431local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
6432commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
6433tracepoint was hit.
6434
6435This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
6436conditions and actions.
6437
6438@menu
6439* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
6440* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
6441* Tracepoint Passcounts::
6442* Tracepoint Actions::
6443* Listing Tracepoints::
6444* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
6445@end menu
6446
6447@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
6448@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
6449
6450@table @code
6451@cindex set tracepoint
6452@kindex trace
6453@item trace
6454The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
6455Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
6456the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
6457defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
6458debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
6459program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
6460doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
6461cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
6462running.
6463
6464Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
6465
6466@smallexample
6467(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
6468
6469(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
6470
6471(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
6472
6473(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
6474
6475(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
6476@end smallexample
6477
6478@noindent
6479You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
6480
6481@vindex $tpnum
6482@cindex last tracepoint number
6483@cindex recent tracepoint number
6484@cindex tracepoint number
6485The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
6486of the most recently set tracepoint.
6487
6488@kindex delete tracepoint
6489@cindex tracepoint deletion
6490@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6491Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
6492default is to delete all tracepoints.
6493
6494Examples:
6495
6496@smallexample
6497(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
6498
6499(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
6500@end smallexample
6501
6502@noindent
6503You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
6504@end table
6505
6506@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6507@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6508
6509@table @code
6510@kindex disable tracepoint
6511@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6512Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
6513@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
6514the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
6515a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
6516
6517@kindex enable tracepoint
6518@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6519Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
6520tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
6521run.
6522@end table
6523
6524@node Tracepoint Passcounts
6525@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
6526
6527@table @code
6528@kindex passcount
6529@cindex tracepoint pass count
6530@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
6531Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
6532automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
6533@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
6534the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
6535@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
6536passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
6537given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
6538user.
6539
6540Examples:
6541
6542@smallexample
6826cf00
EZ
6543(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
6544@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
b37052ae
EZ
6545
6546(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
6826cf00 6547@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
b37052ae
EZ
6548(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6549(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
6550(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
6551(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
6552(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
6553(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
6826cf00
EZ
6554@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
6555@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
6556@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
b37052ae
EZ
6557@end smallexample
6558@end table
6559
6560@node Tracepoint Actions
6561@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
6562
6563@table @code
6564@kindex actions
6565@cindex tracepoint actions
6566@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6567This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
6568tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
6569specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
6570recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
6571@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
6572actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
6573terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
6574far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
6575@code{while-stepping}.
6576
6577@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
6578To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
6579and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
6580
6581@smallexample
6582(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
6583
6826cf00 6584(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
b37052ae 6585
6826cf00 6586(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
b37052ae
EZ
6587@end smallexample
6588
6589In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
6590commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
6591hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
6592following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
6593followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
6594@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
6595@code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
6596@code{end} command.
6597
6598@smallexample
6599(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6600(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6601Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
6602> collect bar,baz
6603> collect $regs
6604> while-stepping 12
6605 > collect $fp, $sp
6606 > end
6607end
6608@end smallexample
6609
6610@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
6611@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
6612Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
6613This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
6614In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
6615special arguments are supported:
6616
6617@table @code
6618@item $regs
6619collect all registers
6620
6621@item $args
6622collect all function arguments
6623
6624@item $locals
6625collect all local variables.
6626@end table
6627
6628You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
6629with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
6630arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
6631
f5c37c66
EZ
6632The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
6633particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
6634
b37052ae
EZ
6635@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
6636@item while-stepping @var{n}
6637Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
6638new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
6639followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
6640its own @code{end} command):
6641
6642@smallexample
6643> while-stepping 12
6644 > collect $regs, myglobal
6645 > end
6646>
6647@end smallexample
6648
6649@noindent
6650You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
6651@code{stepping}.
6652@end table
6653
6654@node Listing Tracepoints
6655@subsection Listing Tracepoints
6656
6657@table @code
6658@kindex info tracepoints
6659@cindex information about tracepoints
6660@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8a037dd7 6661Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
798c8bc6 6662a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
b37052ae
EZ
6663defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
6664shown:
6665
6666@itemize @bullet
6667@item
6668its number
6669@item
6670whether it is enabled or disabled
6671@item
6672its address
6673@item
6674its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
6675@item
6676its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
6677@item
6678where in the source files is the tracepoint set
6679@item
6680its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
6681@end itemize
6682
6683@smallexample
6684(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
6685Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
66861 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
6826cf00
EZ
66872 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
66883 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
b37052ae
EZ
6689(@value{GDBP})
6690@end smallexample
6691
6692@noindent
6693This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
6694@end table
6695
6696@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6697@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6698
6699@table @code
6700@kindex tstart
6701@cindex start a new trace experiment
6702@cindex collected data discarded
6703@item tstart
6704This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
6705begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
6706the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
6707experiment.
6708
6709@kindex tstop
6710@cindex stop a running trace experiment
6711@item tstop
6712This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
6713stops collecting data.
6714
6715@strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
6716automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
6717(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
6718
6719@kindex tstatus
6720@cindex status of trace data collection
6721@cindex trace experiment, status of
6722@item tstatus
6723This command displays the status of the current trace data
6724collection.
6725@end table
6726
6727Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6728
6729@smallexample
6730(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6731(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6732Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6733> collect $regs,$locals,$args
6734> while-stepping 11
6735 > collect $regs
6736 > end
6737> end
6738(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6739 [time passes @dots{}]
6740(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6741@end smallexample
6742
6743
6744@node Analyze Collected Data
6745@section Using the collected data
6746
6747After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6748for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6749collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6750snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6751consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6752examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6753specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6754snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6755registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6756rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6757debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6758(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6759behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6760when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6761the buffer will fail.
6762
6763@menu
6764* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6765* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6766* save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6767@end menu
6768
6769@node tfind
6770@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6771
6772@kindex tfind
6773@cindex select trace snapshot
6774@cindex find trace snapshot
6775The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6776@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6777counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6778snapshot is selected.
6779
6780Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6781
6782@table @code
6783@item tfind start
6784Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6785@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6786
6787@item tfind none
6788Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6789
6790@item tfind end
6791Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6792
6793@item tfind
6794No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6795
6796@item tfind -
6797Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6798retracing earlier steps.
6799
6800@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6801Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6802proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6803argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6804for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6805
6806@item tfind pc @var{addr}
6807Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6808program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6809snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6810snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6811
6812@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6813Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6814addresses.
6815
6816@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6817Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6818@var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6819
6820@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6821Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6822the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6823that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6824trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6825next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6826@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6827stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6828@end table
6829
6830The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6831designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6832instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6833snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6834trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6835simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6836snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6837@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6838The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6839for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6840no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6841(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6842no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6843tracepoint as the current one.
6844
6845In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6846these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6847scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6848you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6849registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6850
6851@smallexample
6852(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6853(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6854> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6855 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6856> tfind
6857> end
6858
6859Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6860Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6861Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6862Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6863Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6864Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6865Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6866Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6867Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6868Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6869Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6870@end smallexample
6871
6872Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6873the buffer:
6874
6875@smallexample
6876(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6877(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6878> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6879> tfind line
6880> end
6881
6882Frame 0, X = 1
6883Frame 7, X = 2
6884Frame 13, X = 255
6885@end smallexample
6886
6887@node tdump
6888@subsection @code{tdump}
6889@kindex tdump
6890@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6891@cindex tracepoint data, display
6892
6893This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6894the current trace snapshot.
6895
6896@smallexample
6897(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6898(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6899Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6900> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6901> end
6902
6903(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6904
6905(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6906#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6907at gdb_test.c:444
6908444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6909
6910(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6911Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6912d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6913d1 0x18 24
6914d2 0x80 128
6915d3 0x33 51
6916d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6917d5 0x22 34
6918d6 0xe0 224
6919d7 0x380035 3670069
6920a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6921a1 0x3000668 50333288
6922a2 0x100 256
6923a3 0x322000 3284992
6924a4 0x3000698 50333336
6925a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6926fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6927sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6928ps 0x0 0
6929pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6930fpcontrol 0x0 0
6931fpstatus 0x0 0
6932fpiaddr 0x0 0
6933p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6934p1 = (void *) 0x11
6935p2 = (void *) 0x22
6936p3 = (void *) 0x33
6937p4 = (void *) 0x44
6938p5 = (void *) 0x55
6939p6 = (void *) 0x66
6940gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6941
6942(@value{GDBP})
6943@end smallexample
6944
6945@node save-tracepoints
6946@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6947@kindex save-tracepoints
6948@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6949
6950This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6951their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6952suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6953tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6954Files}).
6955
6956@node Tracepoint Variables
6957@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6958@cindex tracepoint variables
6959@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6960
6961@table @code
6962@vindex $trace_frame
6963@item (int) $trace_frame
6964The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6965snapshot is selected.
6966
6967@vindex $tracepoint
6968@item (int) $tracepoint
6969The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6970
6971@vindex $trace_line
6972@item (int) $trace_line
6973The line number for the current trace snapshot.
6974
6975@vindex $trace_file
6976@item (char []) $trace_file
6977The source file for the current trace snapshot.
6978
6979@vindex $trace_func
6980@item (char []) $trace_func
6981The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
6982@end table
6983
6984Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
6985use @code{output} instead.
6986
6987Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
6988stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
6989data.
6990
6991@smallexample
6992(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6993
6994(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
6995> output $trace_file
6996> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
6997> tfind
6998> end
6999@end smallexample
7000
df0cd8c5
JB
7001@node Overlays
7002@chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
7003@cindex overlays
7004
7005If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
7006memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
7007problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
7008use overlays.
7009
7010@menu
7011* How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
7012* Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
7013* Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
7014 mapped by asking the inferior.
7015* Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
7016@end menu
7017
7018@node How Overlays Work
7019@section How Overlays Work
7020@cindex mapped overlays
7021@cindex unmapped overlays
7022@cindex load address, overlay's
7023@cindex mapped address
7024@cindex overlay area
7025
7026Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
7027kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
7028other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
7029management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
7030adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
7031
7032One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
7033independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
7034@dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
7035their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
7036instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
7037largest overlay as well.
7038
7039Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
7040overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
7041for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
7042there.
7043
c928edc0
AC
7044@c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
7045@c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
7046@c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
7047
474c8240 7048@smallexample
df0cd8c5 7049@group
c928edc0
AC
7050 Data Instruction Larger
7051Address Space Address Space Address Space
7052+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
7053| | | | | |
7054+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
7055| program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
7056| variables | | program | | +-----------+
7057| and heap | | | | | |
7058+-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
7059| | +-----------+ | | | load address
7060+-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
7061 | | | | | |
7062 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
7063 address | | | | | |
7064 | overlay | <-' | | |
7065 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
7066 | | <---. | | load address
7067 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
7068 | | | |
7069 +-----------+ | |
7070 +-----------+
7071 | |
7072 +-----------+
7073
7074 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
df0cd8c5 7075@end group
474c8240 7076@end smallexample
df0cd8c5 7077
c928edc0
AC
7078The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
7079and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
7080its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
7081Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
7082may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
7083data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
7084program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
7085program and the overlay area.
df0cd8c5
JB
7086
7087An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
7088@dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
7089instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
7090in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
7091is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
7092the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
7093called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
7094
7095Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
7096program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
7097global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
7098
7099@itemize @bullet
7100
7101@item
7102Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
7103must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
7104return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
7105overlay, and your program will probably crash.
7106
7107@item
7108If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
7109will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
7110your program's performance.
7111
7112@item
7113The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
7114overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
7115mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
7116and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
7117You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
7118addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
7119ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
7120
7121@item
7122The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
7123to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
7124instruction and data spaces.
7125
7126@end itemize
7127
7128The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
7129improved in many ways:
7130
7131@itemize @bullet
7132
7133@item
7134If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
7135hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
7136contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
7137This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
7138area in the usual way.
7139
7140@item
7141If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
7142overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
7143
7144@item
7145You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
7146general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
7147code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
7148return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
7149the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
7150must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
7151different data overlay into the same mapped area.
7152
7153@end itemize
7154
7155
7156@node Overlay Commands
7157@section Overlay Commands
7158
7159To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
7160correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
7161virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
7162mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
7163@value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
7164variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
7165
7166@value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
7167you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
7168
7169@table @code
7170@item overlay off
7171@kindex overlay off
7172Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
7173disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
7174always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
7175overlay support is disabled.
7176
7177@item overlay manual
7178@kindex overlay manual
7179@cindex manual overlay debugging
7180Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7181relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
7182using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
7183commands described below.
7184
7185@item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
7186@itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
7187@kindex overlay map-overlay
7188@cindex map an overlay
7189Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
7190be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
7191overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
7192functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
7193that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
7194@var{overlay} are now unmapped.
7195
7196@item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
7197@itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
7198@kindex overlay unmap-overlay
7199@cindex unmap an overlay
7200Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
7201must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
7202When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
7203overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
7204
7205@item overlay auto
7206@kindex overlay auto
7207Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7208consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
7209to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
7210Overlay Debugging}.
7211
7212@item overlay load-target
7213@itemx overlay load
7214@kindex overlay load-target
7215@cindex reloading the overlay table
7216Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
7217re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
7218stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
7219overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
7220useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
7221
7222@item overlay list-overlays
7223@itemx overlay list
7224@cindex listing mapped overlays
7225Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
7226addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
7227
7228@end table
7229
7230Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
7231of the function the address falls in:
7232
474c8240 7233@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7234(gdb) print main
7235$3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
474c8240 7236@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7237@noindent
7238When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
7239unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
7240asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
7241unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
7242
474c8240 7243@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7244(gdb) overlay list
7245No sections are mapped.
7246(gdb) print foo
7247$5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
474c8240 7248@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7249@noindent
7250When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
7251name normally:
7252
474c8240 7253@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7254(gdb) overlay list
7255Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
7256 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
7257(gdb) print foo
7258$6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
474c8240 7259@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7260
7261When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
7262address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
7263overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
7264@code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
7265code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
7266
7267@itemize @bullet
7268@item
7269@cindex breakpoints in overlays
7270@cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
7271You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
7272@value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
7273@item
7274@value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
7275unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
7276overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
7277you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
7278breakpoints properly.
7279@end itemize
7280
7281
7282@node Automatic Overlay Debugging
7283@section Automatic Overlay Debugging
7284@cindex automatic overlay debugging
7285
7286@value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
7287are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
7288inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
7289@code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
7290looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
7291current state of the overlays.
7292
7293Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
7294@value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
7295
7296@table @asis
7297
7298@item @code{_ovly_table}:
7299This variable must be an array of the following structures:
7300
474c8240 7301@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7302struct
7303@{
7304 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
7305 unsigned long vma;
7306
7307 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
7308 unsigned long size;
7309
7310 /* The overlay's load address. */
7311 unsigned long lma;
7312
7313 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
7314 zero otherwise. */
7315 unsigned long mapped;
7316@}
474c8240 7317@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7318
7319@item @code{_novlys}:
7320This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
7321number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
7322
7323@end table
7324
7325To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
7326looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
7327@code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
7328executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
7329the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
7330currently mapped.
7331
81d46470 7332In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
def71bfa 7333@code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
81d46470
MS
7334will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
7335calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
7336will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
7337are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
7338in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
7339overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
7340are not being executed.
df0cd8c5
JB
7341
7342@node Overlay Sample Program
7343@section Overlay Sample Program
7344@cindex overlay example program
7345
7346When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
7347at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
7348addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
7349Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
7350since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
7351architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
7352portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
7353
7354However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
7355program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
7356suite. The program consists of the following files from
7357@file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
7358
7359@table @file
7360@item overlays.c
7361The main program file.
7362@item ovlymgr.c
7363A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
7364@item foo.c
7365@itemx bar.c
7366@itemx baz.c
7367@itemx grbx.c
7368Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
7369@item d10v.ld
7370@itemx m32r.ld
7371Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
7372and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
7373@end table
7374
7375You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
7376cross-compiler like this:
7377
474c8240 7378@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7379$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
7380$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
7381$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
7382$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
7383$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
7384$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
7385$ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
7386 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
474c8240 7387@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7388
7389The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
7390you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
7391target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
7392
7393
6d2ebf8b 7394@node Languages
c906108c
SS
7395@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
7396@cindex languages
7397
c906108c
SS
7398Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
7399rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
7400dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
7401Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5d161b24 7402represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
c906108c 7403@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
7404
7405@cindex working language
7406Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
7407allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
7408native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
7409consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
7410language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
7411language}.
7412
7413@menu
7414* Setting:: Switching between source languages
7415* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 7416* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
7417* Support:: Supported languages
7418@end menu
7419
6d2ebf8b 7420@node Setting
c906108c
SS
7421@section Switching between source languages
7422
7423There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
7424set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
7425@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
7426defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
7427used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
7428are printed, etc.
7429
7430In addition to the working language, every source file that
7431@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
7432file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
7433source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
7434language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
b37052ae 7435controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
c906108c 7436show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
7437set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
7438set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
7439Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
7440
7441This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5d161b24 7442as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
c906108c
SS
7443another language. In that case, make the
7444program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
7445@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
7446program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
7447
7448@menu
7449* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
7450* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
7451* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7452@end menu
7453
6d2ebf8b 7454@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
7455@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
7456
7457If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
7458@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
7459
7460@table @file
7461
7462@item .c
7463C source file
7464
7465@item .C
7466@itemx .cc
7467@itemx .cp
7468@itemx .cpp
7469@itemx .cxx
7470@itemx .c++
b37052ae 7471C@t{++} source file
c906108c
SS
7472
7473@item .f
7474@itemx .F
7475Fortran source file
7476
c906108c
SS
7477@item .mod
7478Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
7479
7480@item .s
7481@itemx .S
7482Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
7483@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
7484@end table
7485
7486In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
7487extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
7488
6d2ebf8b 7489@node Manually
c906108c
SS
7490@subsection Setting the working language
7491
7492If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
7493expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
7494your program.
7495
7496@kindex set language
7497If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
7498command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5d161b24 7499a language, such as
c906108c 7500@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
7501For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
7502
c906108c
SS
7503Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
7504language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
7505to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
7506source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
7507languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
7508source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
7509command such as:
7510
474c8240 7511@smallexample
c906108c 7512print a = b + c
474c8240 7513@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
7514
7515@noindent
7516might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
7517@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
7518printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
7519@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 7520
6d2ebf8b 7521@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
7522@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7523
7524To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
7525@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
7526then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
7527frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
7528working language to the language recorded for the function in that
7529frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
7530or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
7531does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
7532not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
7533
7534This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
7535entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
7536written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
7537a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
7538case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
7539
6d2ebf8b 7540@node Show
c906108c 7541@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
7542
7543The following commands help you find out which language is the
7544working language, and also what language source files were written in.
7545
7546@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
7547@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
7548@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
7549@table @code
7550@item show language
7551Display the current working language. This is the
7552language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
7553build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
7554
7555@item info frame
5d161b24 7556Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
c906108c 7557working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5d161b24 7558@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
7559information listed here.
7560
7561@item info source
7562Display the source language of this source file.
5d161b24 7563@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
7564information listed here.
7565@end table
7566
7567In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
7568not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
7569with a language explicitly:
7570
7571@kindex set extension-language
7572@kindex info extensions
7573@table @code
7574@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
7575Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
7576the source language @var{language}.
7577
7578@item info extensions
7579List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
7580@end table
7581
6d2ebf8b 7582@node Checks
c906108c
SS
7583@section Type and range checking
7584
7585@quotation
7586@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
7587checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
7588section documents the intended facilities.
7589@end quotation
7590@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
7591
7592Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
7593errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
7594checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
7595sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
7596these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
7597by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
7598errors when your program is running.
7599
7600@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
7601Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
7602can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
7603the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
7604@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
7605your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
7606for the default settings of supported languages.
7607
7608@menu
7609* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
7610* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
7611@end menu
7612
7613@cindex type checking
7614@cindex checks, type
6d2ebf8b 7615@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
7616@subsection An overview of type checking
7617
7618Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
7619arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
7620otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
7621errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
7622
7623@smallexample
76241 + 2 @result{} 3
7625@exdent but
7626@error{} 1 + 2.3
7627@end smallexample
7628
7629The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
7630type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
7631
5d161b24
DB
7632For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
7633@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
7634to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
7635or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
c906108c
SS
7636but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
7637these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
7638also issues a warning.
7639
5d161b24
DB
7640Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
7641related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
7642For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
7643a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
7644with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
c906108c
SS
7645the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
7646
7647Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
7648instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
7649operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
7650represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
7651operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
7652details on specific languages.
7653
7654@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
7655
d4f3574e 7656@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
7657@kindex set check type
7658@kindex show check type
7659@table @code
7660@item set check type auto
7661Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
7662@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7663each language.
7664
7665@item set check type on
7666@itemx set check type off
7667Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7668current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
7669match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 7670evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
7671message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
7672
7673@item set check type warn
7674Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
7675evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
7676be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
7677numbers and structures.
7678
7679@item show type
5d161b24 7680Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
7681is setting it automatically.
7682@end table
7683
7684@cindex range checking
7685@cindex checks, range
6d2ebf8b 7686@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
7687@subsection An overview of range checking
7688
7689In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
7690bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
7691checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
7692computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
7693not exceed the bounds of the array.
7694
7695For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
7696@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
7697always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
7698warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
7699
7700A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
7701array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
7702of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
7703error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
7704result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
7705the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
7706
474c8240 7707@smallexample
c906108c 7708@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
474c8240 7709@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
7710
7711This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
7712specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
7713Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
7714
7715@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
7716
d4f3574e 7717@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
7718@kindex set check range
7719@kindex show check range
7720@table @code
7721@item set check range auto
7722Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
7723@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7724each language.
7725
7726@item set check range on
7727@itemx set check range off
7728Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7729current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
7730match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
7731then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
7732
7733@item set check range warn
7734Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
7735but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
7736expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
7737memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
7738systems).
7739
7740@item show range
7741Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
7742being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
7743@end table
c906108c 7744
6d2ebf8b 7745@node Support
c906108c 7746@section Supported languages
c906108c 7747
e632838e 7748@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java, assembly, and Modula-2.
cce74817 7749@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
7750Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
7751language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
7752and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
7753,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
7754language.
7755
7756The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
7757supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
7758tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
7759@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
7760formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
7761books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
7762language reference or tutorial.
7763
c906108c 7764@menu
b37052ae 7765* C:: C and C@t{++}
cce74817 7766* Modula-2:: Modula-2
c906108c
SS
7767@end menu
7768
6d2ebf8b 7769@node C
b37052ae 7770@subsection C and C@t{++}
7a292a7a 7771
b37052ae
EZ
7772@cindex C and C@t{++}
7773@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
c906108c 7774
b37052ae 7775Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
c906108c
SS
7776to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
7777together.
7778
41afff9a
EZ
7779@cindex C@t{++}
7780@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
b37052ae
EZ
7781@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
7782The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
7783compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
7784effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
7785C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7786compiler (@code{aCC}).
7787
b37052ae 7788For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the stabs debugging
c906108c
SS
7789format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
7790command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
7791@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
7792CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
c906108c 7793
c906108c 7794@menu
b37052ae
EZ
7795* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
7796* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
7797* C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
7798* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
7799* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
c906108c 7800* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
b37052ae 7801* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 7802@end menu
c906108c 7803
6d2ebf8b 7804@node C Operators
b37052ae 7805@subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7a292a7a 7806
b37052ae 7807@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
c906108c
SS
7808
7809Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7810@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5d161b24 7811often defined on groups of types.
c906108c 7812
b37052ae 7813For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
7814
7815@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 7816
c906108c 7817@item
c906108c 7818@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
b37052ae 7819specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
7820
7821@item
d4f3574e
SS
7822@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
7823@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
7824
7825@item
53a5351d 7826@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
7827
7828@item
7829@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 7830
c906108c
SS
7831@end itemize
7832
7833@noindent
7834The following operators are supported. They are listed here
7835in order of increasing precedence:
7836
7837@table @code
7838@item ,
7839The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
7840are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
7841expression being the last expression evaluated.
7842
7843@item =
7844Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
7845assigned. Defined on scalar types.
7846
7847@item @var{op}=
7848Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
7849and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 7850@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
7851@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
7852@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
7853
7854@item ?:
7855The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
7856of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
7857integral type.
7858
7859@item ||
7860Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7861
7862@item &&
7863Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7864
7865@item |
7866Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7867
7868@item ^
7869Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7870
7871@item &
7872Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7873
7874@item ==@r{, }!=
7875Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
7876expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
7877
7878@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
7879Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
7880Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
7881and non-zero for true.
7882
7883@item <<@r{, }>>
7884left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
7885
7886@item @@
7887The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7888
7889@item +@r{, }-
7890Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
7891pointer types.
7892
7893@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
7894Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
7895defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
7896integral types.
7897
7898@item ++@r{, }--
7899Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
7900operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
7901when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
7902operation takes place.
7903
7904@item *
7905Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
7906@code{++}.
7907
7908@item &
7909Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
7910
b37052ae
EZ
7911For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
7912allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
c906108c 7913(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
b37052ae 7914where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
c906108c 7915stored.
c906108c
SS
7916
7917@item -
7918Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
7919precedence as @code{++}.
7920
7921@item !
7922Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7923@code{++}.
7924
7925@item ~
7926Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7927@code{++}.
7928
7929
7930@item .@r{, }->
7931Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
7932@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
7933pointer based on the stored type information.
7934Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
7935
c906108c
SS
7936@item .*@r{, }->*
7937Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
7938
7939@item []
7940Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
7941@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7942
7943@item ()
7944Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7945
c906108c 7946@item ::
b37052ae 7947C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7a292a7a 7948and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
7949
7950@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
7951Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
7952(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
7953above.
c906108c
SS
7954@end table
7955
c906108c
SS
7956If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
7957attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
7958predefined meaning.
c906108c 7959
c906108c 7960@menu
5d161b24 7961* C Constants::
c906108c
SS
7962@end menu
7963
6d2ebf8b 7964@node C Constants
b37052ae 7965@subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7966
b37052ae 7967@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7968
b37052ae 7969@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
c906108c 7970following ways:
c906108c
SS
7971
7972@itemize @bullet
7973@item
7974Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6ca652b0
EZ
7975specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
7976by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
c906108c
SS
7977@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
7978@code{long} value.
7979
7980@item
7981Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
7982point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
7983exponent. An exponent is of the form:
7984@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
7985sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
7986A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
7987@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
7988the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
7989a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
7990constant.
c906108c
SS
7991
7992@item
7993Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
7994integral equivalents.
7995
7996@item
7997Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
7998(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 7999(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
8000be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
8001the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
8002of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
8003@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
8004@samp{\n} for newline.
8005
8006@item
96a2c332
SS
8007String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
8008double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
8009above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
8010a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
8011characters.
c906108c
SS
8012
8013@item
8014Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
8015to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
8016
8017@item
8018Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
8019and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
8020integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
8021and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
8022@end itemize
8023
c906108c 8024@menu
5d161b24
DB
8025* C plus plus expressions::
8026* C Defaults::
8027* C Checks::
c906108c 8028
5d161b24 8029* Debugging C::
c906108c
SS
8030@end menu
8031
6d2ebf8b 8032@node C plus plus expressions
b37052ae
EZ
8033@subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
8034
8035@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
8036@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
8037
8038@cindex C@t{++} support, not in @sc{coff}
8039@cindex @sc{coff} versus C@t{++}
8040@cindex C@t{++} and object formats
8041@cindex object formats and C@t{++}
8042@cindex a.out and C@t{++}
8043@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C@t{++}
8044@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C@t{++}
8045@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C@t{++}
8046@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8047@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
8048@c periodically whether this has happened...
8049@quotation
b37052ae
EZ
8050@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
8051proper compiler. Typically, C@t{++} debugging depends on the use of
c906108c
SS
8052additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
8053special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
8054@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
8055symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
8056you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
8057extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
b37052ae 8058@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8059support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
8060@end quotation
c906108c
SS
8061
8062@enumerate
8063
8064@cindex member functions
8065@item
8066Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
8067
474c8240 8068@smallexample
c906108c 8069count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
474c8240 8070@end smallexample
c906108c 8071
41afff9a 8072@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
b37052ae 8073@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8074@item
8075While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
8076expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
8077that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
b37052ae 8078pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
c906108c 8079
c906108c 8080@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 8081@cindex overloaded functions, calling
b37052ae 8082@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8083@item
8084You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 8085call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
8086perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
8087calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
8088in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
8089default arguments.
8090
8091It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
8092promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
8093class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
8094functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
8095number of function arguments.
8096
8097Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
8098@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
b37052ae 8099,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c 8100
d4f3574e 8101You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
8102explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
8103@smallexample
8104p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
8105@end smallexample
d4f3574e 8106
c906108c 8107The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 8108see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 8109
c906108c
SS
8110@cindex reference declarations
8111@item
b37052ae
EZ
8112@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
8113them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
c906108c
SS
8114dereferenced.
8115
8116In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
8117reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
8118avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
8119The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
8120you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
8121
8122@item
b37052ae 8123@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
c906108c
SS
8124expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
8125one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
8126necessary, for example in an expression like
8127@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
b37052ae 8128resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8129debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
8130@end enumerate
8131
b37052ae 8132In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
53a5351d
JM
8133calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
8134objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
8135invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 8136
6d2ebf8b 8137@node C Defaults
b37052ae 8138@subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
7a292a7a 8139
b37052ae 8140@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
c906108c 8141
c906108c
SS
8142If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
8143both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
b37052ae 8144C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c 8145selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
8146
8147If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
8148recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
8149@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
b37052ae 8150these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
c906108c
SS
8151@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
8152for further details.
8153
c906108c
SS
8154@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
8155@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
8156@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 8157
6d2ebf8b 8158@node C Checks
b37052ae 8159@subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7a292a7a 8160
b37052ae 8161@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
c906108c 8162
b37052ae 8163By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
c906108c
SS
8164is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
8165considers two variables type equivalent if:
8166
8167@itemize @bullet
8168@item
8169The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
8170enumerated tag.
8171
8172@item
8173The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
8174declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
8175
8176@ignore
8177@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
8178@c FIXME--beers?
8179@item
8180The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
8181declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
8182compilers.)
8183@end ignore
8184@end itemize
8185
8186Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
8187indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
8188that is not itself an array.
c906108c 8189
6d2ebf8b 8190@node Debugging C
c906108c 8191@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
8192
8193The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
8194the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
8195inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
8196appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
8197
8198The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
8199with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
8200,Expressions}.
8201
c906108c 8202@menu
5d161b24 8203* Debugging C plus plus::
c906108c
SS
8204@end menu
8205
6d2ebf8b 8206@node Debugging C plus plus
b37052ae 8207@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 8208
b37052ae 8209@cindex commands for C@t{++}
7a292a7a 8210
b37052ae
EZ
8211Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
8212designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
c906108c
SS
8213
8214@table @code
8215@cindex break in overloaded functions
8216@item @r{breakpoint menus}
8217When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
8218@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
8219you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
8220
b37052ae 8221@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8222@item rbreak @var{regex}
8223Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
8224breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
8225classes.
8226@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
8227
b37052ae 8228@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
8229@item catch throw
8230@itemx catch catch
b37052ae 8231Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
c906108c
SS
8232Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
8233
8234@cindex inheritance
8235@item ptype @var{typename}
8236Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
8237@var{typename}.
8238@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
8239
b37052ae 8240@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
c906108c
SS
8241@item set print demangle
8242@itemx show print demangle
8243@itemx set print asm-demangle
8244@itemx show print asm-demangle
b37052ae
EZ
8245Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
8246displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
c906108c
SS
8247@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8248
8249@item set print object
8250@itemx show print object
8251Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
8252@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8253
8254@item set print vtbl
8255@itemx show print vtbl
8256Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
8257@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c 8258(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 8259ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
8260
8261@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 8262@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c 8263@item set overload-resolution on
b37052ae 8264Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
c906108c
SS
8265is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
8266and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
b37052ae 8267using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
d4f3574e 8268expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
8269message.
8270
8271@item set overload-resolution off
b37052ae 8272Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
c906108c
SS
8273overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8274chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
8275symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
8276overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8277searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
8278argument types.
c906108c
SS
8279
8280@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
8281You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
b37052ae 8282the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
c906108c
SS
8283@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
8284also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
8285available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
8286@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
8287@end table
c906108c 8288
6d2ebf8b 8289@node Modula-2
c906108c 8290@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 8291
d4f3574e 8292@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
8293
8294The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
8295output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
8296developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
8297attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
8298to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8299table.
8300
8301@cindex expressions in Modula-2
8302@menu
8303* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
8304* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
8305* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
8306* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
8307* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
8308* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
8309* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8310* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8311@end menu
8312
6d2ebf8b 8313@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
8314@subsubsection Operators
8315@cindex Modula-2 operators
8316
8317Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8318@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
8319often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
8320following definitions hold:
8321
8322@itemize @bullet
8323
8324@item
8325@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
8326their subranges.
8327
8328@item
8329@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
8330
8331@item
8332@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
8333
8334@item
8335@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
8336@var{type}}.
8337
8338@item
8339@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
8340
8341@item
8342@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
8343
8344@item
8345@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
8346@end itemize
8347
8348@noindent
8349The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
8350increasing precedence:
8351
8352@table @code
8353@item ,
8354Function argument or array index separator.
8355
8356@item :=
8357Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
8358@var{value}.
8359
8360@item <@r{, }>
8361Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
8362types.
8363
8364@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 8365Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
8366on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
8367set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
8368
8369@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
8370Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
8371Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
8372available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
8373comment character.
8374
8375@item IN
8376Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
8377Same precedence as @code{<}.
8378
8379@item OR
8380Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
8381
8382@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 8383Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
8384
8385@item @@
8386The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8387
8388@item +@r{, }-
8389Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
8390and difference on set types.
8391
8392@item *
8393Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
8394on set types.
8395
8396@item /
8397Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
8398types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
8399
8400@item DIV@r{, }MOD
8401Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
8402precedence as @code{*}.
8403
8404@item -
8405Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
8406
8407@item ^
8408Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
8409
8410@item NOT
8411Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
8412@code{^}.
8413
8414@item .
8415@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
8416precedence as @code{^}.
8417
8418@item []
8419Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
8420
8421@item ()
8422Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
8423as @code{^}.
8424
8425@item ::@r{, }.
8426@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
8427@end table
8428
8429@quotation
8430@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
8431treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
8432@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
8433@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
8434@end quotation
8435
cb51c4e0 8436
6d2ebf8b 8437@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c 8438@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
cb51c4e0 8439@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
c906108c
SS
8440
8441Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
8442In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
8443
8444@table @var
8445
8446@item a
8447represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
8448
8449@item c
8450represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
8451
8452@item i
8453represents a variable or constant of integral type.
8454
8455@item m
8456represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
8457same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
8458be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
8459
8460@item n
8461represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
8462
8463@item r
8464represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
8465
8466@item t
8467represents a type.
8468
8469@item v
8470represents a variable.
8471
8472@item x
8473represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
8474explanation of the function for details.
8475@end table
8476
8477All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
8478
8479@table @code
8480@item ABS(@var{n})
8481Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
8482
8483@item CAP(@var{c})
8484If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 8485equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
8486
8487@item CHR(@var{i})
8488Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8489
8490@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 8491Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
8492
8493@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
8494Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8495new value.
8496
8497@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8498Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
8499set.
8500
8501@item FLOAT(@var{i})
8502Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
8503
8504@item HIGH(@var{a})
8505Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
8506
8507@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 8508Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
8509
8510@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
8511Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8512new value.
8513
8514@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8515Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
8516there. Returns the new set.
8517
8518@item MAX(@var{t})
8519Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
8520
8521@item MIN(@var{t})
8522Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
8523
8524@item ODD(@var{i})
8525Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
8526
8527@item ORD(@var{x})
8528Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
8529value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
8530@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
8531integral, character and enumerated types.
8532
8533@item SIZE(@var{x})
8534Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
8535
8536@item TRUNC(@var{r})
8537Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
8538
8539@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
8540Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8541@end table
8542
8543@quotation
8544@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
8545@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
8546an error.
8547@end quotation
8548
8549@cindex Modula-2 constants
6d2ebf8b 8550@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
8551@subsubsection Constants
8552
8553@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
8554ways:
8555
8556@itemize @bullet
8557
8558@item
8559Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
8560expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
8561rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
8562trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
8563
8564@item
8565Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
8566decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
8567then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
8568@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
8569digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
8570digits.
8571
8572@item
8573Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
8574like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 8575also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
8576followed by a @samp{C}.
8577
8578@item
8579String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
8580pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
8581Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
b37052ae 8582Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
c906108c
SS
8583sequences.
8584
8585@item
8586Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
8587
8588@item
8589Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
8590@code{FALSE}.
8591
8592@item
8593Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
8594
8595@item
8596Set constants are not yet supported.
8597@end itemize
8598
6d2ebf8b 8599@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
8600@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
8601@cindex Modula-2 defaults
8602
8603If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8604both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 8605Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
8606selected the working language.
8607
8608If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8609code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 8610working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
8611the language automatically}, for further details.
8612
6d2ebf8b 8613@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
8614@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
8615@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
8616
8617A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
8618This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
8619
8620@itemize @bullet
8621@item
8622Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
8623integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
8624debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
8625pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
8626through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
8627returned a pointer.)
8628
8629@item
8630C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
8631non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
8632escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
8633printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
8634
8635@item
8636The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
8637argument.
8638
8639@item
8640All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
8641@end itemize
8642
6d2ebf8b 8643@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
8644@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
8645@cindex Modula-2 checks
8646
8647@quotation
8648@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
8649range checking.
8650@end quotation
8651@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
8652
8653@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
8654
8655@itemize @bullet
8656@item
8657They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
8658@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
8659
8660@item
8661They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
8662@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
8663@end itemize
8664
8665As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
8666whose types are not equivalent is an error.
8667
8668Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8669index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
8670
6d2ebf8b 8671@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
8672@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8673@cindex scope
41afff9a 8674@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
c906108c
SS
8675@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
8676@ifinfo
41afff9a 8677@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
8678@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
8679@end ifinfo
8680@iftex
41afff9a 8681@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
8682@end iftex
8683
8684There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
8685(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
8686similar syntax:
8687
474c8240 8688@smallexample
c906108c
SS
8689
8690@var{module} . @var{id}
8691@var{scope} :: @var{id}
474c8240 8692@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8693
8694@noindent
8695where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
8696@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
8697identifier within your program, except another module.
8698
8699Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
8700specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
8701found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
8702enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
8703
8704Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
8705the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
8706definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
8707an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
8708module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
8709@var{module}.
8710
6d2ebf8b 8711@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
8712@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8713
8714Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
8715Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
b37052ae 8716specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
c906108c 8717@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
b37052ae 8718apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
c906108c
SS
8719analogue in Modula-2.
8720
8721The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 8722with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c 8723intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
b37052ae 8724created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
c906108c 8725address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 8726@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
8727
8728@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
8729In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
8730interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 8731
6d2ebf8b 8732@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
8733@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8734
d4f3574e 8735The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
8736symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8737program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8738does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8739program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8740(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8741file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8742
8743@cindex symbol names
8744@cindex names of symbols
8745@cindex quoting names
8746Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8747characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8748most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8749source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8750are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8751ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8752@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8753@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8754
474c8240 8755@smallexample
c906108c 8756p 'foo.c'::x
474c8240 8757@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8758
8759@noindent
8760looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8761
8762@table @code
8763@kindex info address
b37052ae 8764@cindex address of a symbol
c906108c
SS
8765@item info address @var{symbol}
8766Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8767variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8768local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8769is always stored.
8770
8771Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8772at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8773the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8774
3d67e040 8775@kindex info symbol
b37052ae 8776@cindex symbol from address
3d67e040
EZ
8777@item info symbol @var{addr}
8778Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8779If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8780nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8781
474c8240 8782@smallexample
3d67e040
EZ
8783(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8784_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
474c8240 8785@end smallexample
3d67e040
EZ
8786
8787@noindent
8788This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
8789it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8790
c906108c 8791@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
8792@item whatis @var{expr}
8793Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
8794actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8795assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8796@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8797
8798@item whatis
8799Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8800
8801@kindex ptype
8802@item ptype @var{typename}
8803Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
8804the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8805@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8806@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 8807
d4f3574e 8808@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 8809@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 8810Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
8811differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8812of just the name of the type.
8813
8814For example, for this variable declaration:
8815
474c8240 8816@smallexample
c906108c 8817struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
474c8240 8818@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8819
8820@noindent
8821the two commands give this output:
8822
474c8240 8823@smallexample
c906108c
SS
8824@group
8825(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8826type = struct complex
8827(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8828type = struct complex @{
8829 double real;
8830 double imag;
8831@}
8832@end group
474c8240 8833@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8834
8835@noindent
8836As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8837the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8838
8839@kindex info types
8840@item info types @var{regexp}
8841@itemx info types
d4f3574e 8842Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
8843(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
8844complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
8845@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 8846names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
8847information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
8848
8849This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
8850@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
8851lists all source files where a type is defined.
8852
b37052ae
EZ
8853@kindex info scope
8854@cindex local variables
8855@item info scope @var{addr}
8856List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
8857accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
8858preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
8859scope defined by that location. For example:
8860
8861@smallexample
8862(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
8863Scope for command_line_handler:
8864Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
8865Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
8866Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
8867Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
8868Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
8869Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
8870Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
8871@end smallexample
8872
f5c37c66
EZ
8873@noindent
8874This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
8875during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
8876collect}.
8877
c906108c
SS
8878@kindex info source
8879@item info source
919d772c
JB
8880Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
8881the function containing the current point of execution:
8882@itemize @bullet
8883@item
8884the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
8885@item
8886the directory it was compiled in,
8887@item
8888its length, in lines,
8889@item
8890which programming language it is written in,
8891@item
8892whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
8893if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
8894@item
8895whether the debugging information includes information about
8896preprocessor macros.
8897@end itemize
8898
c906108c
SS
8899
8900@kindex info sources
8901@item info sources
8902Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
8903debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
8904have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
8905
8906@kindex info functions
8907@item info functions
8908Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
8909
8910@item info functions @var{regexp}
8911Print the names and data types of all defined functions
8912whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
8913Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
8914include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
1c5dfdad
MS
8915start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
8916that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
8917@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
c906108c
SS
8918
8919@kindex info variables
8920@item info variables
8921Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
6ca652b0 8922outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
c906108c
SS
8923
8924@item info variables @var{regexp}
8925Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
8926variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
8927@var{regexp}.
8928
8929@ignore
8930This was never implemented.
8931@kindex info methods
8932@item info methods
8933@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
8934The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
b37052ae
EZ
8935methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
8936specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
8937C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
c906108c
SS
8938from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
8939@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
8940which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
8941@end ignore
8942
c906108c
SS
8943@cindex reloading symbols
8944Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
8945be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
8946in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
8947running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
8948@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
8949
8950@table @code
8951@kindex set symbol-reloading
8952@item set symbol-reloading on
8953Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
8954object file with a particular name is seen again.
8955
8956@item set symbol-reloading off
6d2ebf8b
SS
8957Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
8958same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
8959running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
8960should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
8961may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
8962several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
8963name.
c906108c
SS
8964
8965@kindex show symbol-reloading
8966@item show symbol-reloading
8967Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
8968@end table
c906108c 8969
c906108c
SS
8970@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
8971@item set opaque-type-resolution on
8972Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
8973declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
8974@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
8975source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
8976another source file. The default is on.
8977
8978A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
8979the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
8980
8981@item set opaque-type-resolution off
8982Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
8983is printed as follows:
8984@smallexample
8985@{<no data fields>@}
8986@end smallexample
8987
8988@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
8989@item show opaque-type-resolution
8990Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
8991
8992@kindex maint print symbols
8993@cindex symbol dump
8994@kindex maint print psymbols
8995@cindex partial symbol dump
8996@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
8997@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
8998@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
8999Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
9000These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
9001symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
9002symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
9003collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
9004only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
9005command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
9006use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
9007symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
9008files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
9009@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
9010required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
9011@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
9012@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
9013@end table
9014
6d2ebf8b 9015@node Altering
c906108c
SS
9016@chapter Altering Execution
9017
9018Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
9019find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
9020correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
9021experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
9022program.
9023
9024For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
9025locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
9026address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
9027
9028@menu
9029* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
9030* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 9031* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
9032* Returning:: Returning from a function
9033* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
9034* Patching:: Patching your program
9035@end menu
9036
6d2ebf8b 9037@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
9038@section Assignment to variables
9039
9040@cindex assignment
9041@cindex setting variables
9042To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
9043@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
9044
474c8240 9045@smallexample
c906108c 9046print x=4
474c8240 9047@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9048
9049@noindent
9050stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
5d161b24 9051value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
9052@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
9053information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
9054
9055@kindex set variable
9056@cindex variables, setting
9057If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
9058@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
9059really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
9060not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
9061,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
9062
c906108c
SS
9063If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
9064appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
9065variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
9066to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
9067program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
9068a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
9069command @code{set width}:
9070
474c8240 9071@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9072(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
9073type = double
9074(@value{GDBP}) p width
9075$4 = 13
9076(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
9077Invalid syntax in expression.
474c8240 9078@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9079
9080@noindent
9081The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
9082order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
9083
474c8240 9084@smallexample
c906108c 9085(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
474c8240 9086@end smallexample
53a5351d 9087
c906108c
SS
9088Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
9089with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
9090@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
9091your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
9092to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
9093the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
9094
474c8240 9095@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9096@group
9097(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
9098type = double
9099(@value{GDBP}) p g
9100$1 = 1
9101(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 9102(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
9103$2 = 1
9104(@value{GDBP}) r
9105The program being debugged has been started already.
9106Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
9107Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
6d2ebf8b
SS
9108"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
9109 Invalid bfd target.
c906108c
SS
9110(@value{GDBP}) show g
9111The current BFD target is "=4".
9112@end group
474c8240 9113@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9114
9115@noindent
9116The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
9117@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
9118@code{g}, use
9119
474c8240 9120@smallexample
c906108c 9121(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
474c8240 9122@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9123
9124@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
9125freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
9126and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
9127same length or shorter.
9128@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
9129@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
9130
9131To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
9132construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
9133(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
9134to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
9135and representation in memory), and
9136
474c8240 9137@smallexample
c906108c 9138set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
474c8240 9139@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9140
9141@noindent
9142stores the value 4 into that memory location.
9143
6d2ebf8b 9144@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
9145@section Continuing at a different address
9146
9147Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
9148it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
9149an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
9150
9151@table @code
9152@kindex jump
9153@item jump @var{linespec}
9154Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
9155immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
9156source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
9157@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
9158in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
9159breakpoints}.
9160
9161The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
9162the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
9163register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
9164a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
9165be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
9166of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
9167confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
9168executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
9169well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
9170
9171@item jump *@var{address}
9172Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
9173@end table
9174
c906108c 9175@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
9176On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
9177command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
9178difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
9179changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
9180example,
c906108c 9181
474c8240 9182@smallexample
c906108c 9183set $pc = 0x485
474c8240 9184@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9185
9186@noindent
9187makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
9188address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
9189@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
9190
9191The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
9192up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
9193that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
9194detail.
9195
c906108c 9196@c @group
6d2ebf8b 9197@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
9198@section Giving your program a signal
9199
9200@table @code
9201@kindex signal
9202@item signal @var{signal}
9203Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
9204signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
9205signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
9206SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
9207
9208Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
9209giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
9210a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
9211@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
9212signal.
9213
9214@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
9215after executing the command.
9216@end table
9217@c @end group
9218
9219Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
9220@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
9221causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
9222the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
9223passes the signal directly to your program.
9224
c906108c 9225
6d2ebf8b 9226@node Returning
c906108c
SS
9227@section Returning from a function
9228
9229@table @code
9230@cindex returning from a function
9231@kindex return
9232@item return
9233@itemx return @var{expression}
9234You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
9235command. If you give an
9236@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
9237value.
9238@end table
9239
9240When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
9241(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
9242discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
9243be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
9244
9245This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
9246frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
9247innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
9248specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
9249of functions.
9250
9251The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
9252program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
9253returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
9254and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
9255selected stack frame returns naturally.
9256
6d2ebf8b 9257@node Calling
c906108c
SS
9258@section Calling program functions
9259
9260@cindex calling functions
9261@kindex call
9262@table @code
9263@item call @var{expr}
9264Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
9265returned values.
9266@end table
9267
9268You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
9269execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
5d161b24
DB
9270with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
9271is printed and saved in the value history.
c906108c 9272
6d2ebf8b 9273@node Patching
c906108c 9274@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 9275
c906108c
SS
9276@cindex patching binaries
9277@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 9278@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 9279
7a292a7a
SS
9280By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
9281executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
9282alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
9283patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
9284
9285If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
9286explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
9287want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
9288repairs.
9289
9290@table @code
9291@kindex set write
9292@item set write on
9293@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
9294If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
9295core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
9296off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
9297
9298If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
9299@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
9300write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
9301
9302@item show write
9303@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
9304Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
9305as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
9306@end table
9307
6d2ebf8b 9308@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
9309@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
9310
7a292a7a
SS
9311@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
9312both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
9313program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
9314@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
9315
9316@menu
9317* Files:: Commands to specify files
9318* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
9319@end menu
9320
6d2ebf8b 9321@node Files
c906108c 9322@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 9323
7a292a7a 9324@cindex symbol table
c906108c 9325@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
9326
9327You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
9328way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
9329@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
9330Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
9331
9332Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
9333@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
9334a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
9335to specify new files are useful.
9336
9337@table @code
9338@cindex executable file
9339@kindex file
9340@item file @var{filename}
9341Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
9342symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
9343executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
5d161b24
DB
9344directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
9345@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
9346directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
9347to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
9348and your program, using the @code{path} command.
9349
6d2ebf8b 9350On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
c906108c
SS
9351@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
9352@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
9353@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
9354descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
9355(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
5d161b24 9356@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
c906108c 9357for more information.
c906108c
SS
9358
9359@item file
9360@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
9361has on both executable file and the symbol table.
9362
9363@kindex exec-file
9364@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9365Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
9366in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
9367if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
9368discard information on the executable file.
9369
9370@kindex symbol-file
9371@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9372Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
9373searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
9374table and program to run from the same file.
9375
9376@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
9377program's symbol table.
9378
5d161b24 9379The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
c906108c
SS
9380of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
9381auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
9382the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
9383the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
9384
9385@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
9386executing it once.
9387
9388When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
9389understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
9390generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
9391other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
9392Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
9393using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
9394optimized code.
c906108c
SS
9395
9396For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
9397using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
9398symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
9399quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
9400details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
9401
9402The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
9403start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
9404occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
9405file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
9406pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
9407warnings and messages}.)
9408
c906108c
SS
9409We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
9410symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
9411symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
9412still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
9413in stabs format.
9414
9415@kindex readnow
9416@cindex reading symbols immediately
9417@cindex symbols, reading immediately
9418@kindex mapped
9419@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
9420@cindex saving symbol table
9421@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9422@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9423You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
9424tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
9425load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
5d161b24 9426entire symbol table available.
c906108c 9427
c906108c
SS
9428If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
9429@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
9430cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
9431file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
9432from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
9433than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
9434program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
9435starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
9436
9437You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
9438file has all the symbol information for your program.
9439
9440The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
9441@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
9442than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
9443it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
9444needed.
9445
9446The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
9447@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
9448symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
9449
9450@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
9451@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
9452@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
9453@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
9454@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
9455@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
9456@c files.
9457
9458@kindex core
9459@kindex core-file
9460@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9461Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
9462of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
9463address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
9464executable file itself for other parts.
9465
9466@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
9467to be used.
9468
9469Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
9470under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
9471wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
9472the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 9473(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 9474
c906108c
SS
9475@kindex add-symbol-file
9476@cindex dynamic linking
9477@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
9478@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
17d9d558 9479@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
96a2c332
SS
9480The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
9481information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
9482when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
9483into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
9484address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
d167840f
EZ
9485this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
9486of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
9487section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
9488@var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
9489
9490The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
9491originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
9492@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
9493thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
9494instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c 9495
17d9d558
JB
9496@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
9497@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
9498@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
9499@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
9500@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
9501Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
9502executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
9503relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
9504information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
9505
9506@itemize @bullet
9507@item
9508the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
9509that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
9510@item
9511every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
9512been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
9513@item
9514you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
9515provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9516@end itemize
9517
9518@noindent
9519Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
9520relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
9521typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
9522important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
9523procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C++ constructor table
9524assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
9525general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
9526relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
9527as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
9528way.
9529
c906108c
SS
9530@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9531
9532You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
9533the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
9534table information for @var{filename}.
9535
9536@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
9537@item add-shared-symbol-file
9538The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
5d161b24
DB
9539operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
9540shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
c906108c 9541@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 9542
c906108c
SS
9543@kindex section
9544@item section
5d161b24
DB
9545The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
9546the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
9547section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
9548specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
9549separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
9550the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
9551
9552@kindex info files
9553@kindex info target
9554@item info files
9555@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
9556@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
9557current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
9558including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
9559use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
9560command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
9561current ones.
9562
fe95c787
MS
9563@kindex maint info sections
9564@item maint info sections
9565Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
9566is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
9567displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
9568offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
9569@code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
9570may be arbitrarily combined):
9571
9572@table @code
9573@item ALLOBJ
9574Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
9575@item @var{sections}
6600abed 9576Display info only for named @var{sections}.
fe95c787
MS
9577@item @var{section-flags}
9578Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
9579The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
9580@table @code
9581@item ALLOC
9582Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
9583Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
9584@item LOAD
9585Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
9586Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
9587@item RELOC
9588Section needs to be relocated before loading.
9589@item READONLY
9590Section cannot be modified by the child process.
9591@item CODE
9592Section contains executable code only.
6600abed 9593@item DATA
fe95c787
MS
9594Section contains data only (no executable code).
9595@item ROM
9596Section will reside in ROM.
9597@item CONSTRUCTOR
9598Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
9599@item HAS_CONTENTS
9600Section is not empty.
9601@item NEVER_LOAD
9602An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
9603@item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
9604A notification to the linker that the section contains
9605COFF shared library information.
9606@item IS_COMMON
9607Section contains common symbols.
9608@end table
9609@end table
6763aef9
MS
9610@kindex set trust-readonly-sections
9611@item set trust-readonly-sections on
9612Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
6ca652b0 9613really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
6763aef9
MS
9614In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
9615out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
9616For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
9617enhancement to debugging performance.
9618
9619The default is off.
9620
9621@item set trust-readonly-sections off
15110bc3 9622Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
6763aef9
MS
9623the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
9624and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
c906108c
SS
9625@end table
9626
9627All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
9628as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
9629name and remembers it that way.
9630
c906108c 9631@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
9632@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
9633libraries.
53a5351d 9634
c906108c
SS
9635@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
9636when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
9637(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
9638references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
9639debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
9640
9641On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
9642automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
9643
c906108c
SS
9644@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
9645@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
9646@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
9647
b7209cb4
FF
9648There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
9649symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
9650particularly large or there are many of them.
9651
9652To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
9653commands:
9654
9655@table @code
9656@kindex set auto-solib-add
9657@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
9658If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
9659will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
9660attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
9661informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
9662is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9663@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
9664
9665@kindex show auto-solib-add
9666@item show auto-solib-add
9667Display the current autoloading mode.
9668@end table
9669
9670To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
9671command:
9672
c906108c
SS
9673@table @code
9674@kindex info sharedlibrary
9675@kindex info share
9676@item info share
9677@itemx info sharedlibrary
9678Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
9679
9680@kindex sharedlibrary
9681@kindex share
9682@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
9683@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
9684Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
9685Unix regular expression.
9686As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
9687required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
9688@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
9689loaded.
9690@end table
9691
b7209cb4
FF
9692On some systems, such as HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} supports
9693autoloading shared library symbols until a limiting threshold size is
9694reached. This provides the benefit of allowing autoloading to remain on
9695by default, but avoids autoloading excessively large shared libraries,
9696up to a threshold that is initially set, but which you can modify if you
9697wish.
c906108c
SS
9698
9699Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
9700loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
9701@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
9702automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
9703
9704To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
9705
9706@table @code
b7209cb4
FF
9707@kindex set auto-solib-limit
9708@item set auto-solib-limit @var{threshold}
9709Set the autoloading size threshold, in an integral number of megabytes.
9710If @var{threshold} is nonzero and shared library autoloading is enabled,
9711symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded until the total
9712size of the loaded shared library symbols exceeds this threshold.
c906108c 9713Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
6ca652b0 9714@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 (i.e.@: 100
b7209cb4 9715Mb).
c906108c 9716
b7209cb4
FF
9717@kindex show auto-solib-limit
9718@item show auto-solib-limit
c906108c
SS
9719Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
9720@end table
c906108c 9721
6d2ebf8b 9722@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
9723@section Errors reading symbol files
9724
9725While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
9726such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
9727output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
9728they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
9729debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
9730about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
9731only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
9732times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
9733to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
9734complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9735messages}).
9736
9737The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
9738
9739@table @code
9740@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
9741
9742The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
9743(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
9744error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
9745in its outer scope blocks.
9746
9747@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
9748the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
9749may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
9750function.
9751
9752@item block at @var{address} out of order
9753
9754The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
9755order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
9756do so.
9757
9758@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
9759locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
9760can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
9761@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9762messages}.)
9763
9764@item bad block start address patched
9765
9766The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
9767smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
9768to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
9769
9770@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
9771starting on the previous source line.
9772
9773@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
9774
9775@cindex foo
9776Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
9777larger than the size of the string table.
9778
9779@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
9780name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
9781with this name.
9782
9783@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
9784
7a292a7a
SS
9785The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
9786not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 9787uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 9788
7a292a7a
SS
9789@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
9790This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 9791are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
9792debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
9793on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
9794and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
9795
9796@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 9797
7a292a7a 9798@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 9799
7a292a7a 9800@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
b37052ae 9801The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
9802information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
9803it.
c906108c
SS
9804
9805@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
9806
9807@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 9808
c906108c
SS
9809@end table
9810
6d2ebf8b 9811@node Targets
c906108c 9812@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 9813
c906108c
SS
9814@cindex debugging target
9815@kindex target
9816
9817A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
9818
9819Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
9820in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
9821you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
9822flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
9823host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
9824realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
9825command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
9826(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
9827
9828@menu
9829* Active Targets:: Active targets
9830* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
9831* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
9832* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 9833* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
9834
9835@end menu
9836
6d2ebf8b 9837@node Active Targets
c906108c 9838@section Active targets
7a292a7a 9839
c906108c
SS
9840@cindex stacking targets
9841@cindex active targets
9842@cindex multiple targets
9843
c906108c 9844There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
9845executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
9846active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
9847start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
9848a core file.
c906108c
SS
9849
9850For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
9851@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
9852well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
9853@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
9854first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
9855requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
9856are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
9857read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
9858executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
9859
9860When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
9861target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
9862commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
9863an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
9864process target is active.
c906108c 9865
7a292a7a
SS
9866Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
9867core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 9868files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
9869the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
9870process}).
c906108c 9871
6d2ebf8b 9872@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
9873@section Commands for managing targets
9874
9875@table @code
9876@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
9877Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
9878process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
9879facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
9880protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
9881
9882Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
9883typically include things like device names or host names to connect
9884with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
9885
9886The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
9887after executing the command.
9888
9889@kindex help target
9890@item help target
9891Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
9892currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
9893(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
9894
9895@item help target @var{name}
9896Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
9897select it.
9898
9899@kindex set gnutarget
9900@item set gnutarget @var{args}
5d161b24 9901@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
c906108c 9902knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
5d161b24
DB
9903a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
9904with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
c906108c
SS
9905with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
9906
d4f3574e 9907@quotation
c906108c
SS
9908@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
9909you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 9910@end quotation
c906108c 9911
d4f3574e
SS
9912@noindent
9913@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c 9914
5d161b24 9915@kindex show gnutarget
c906108c
SS
9916@item show gnutarget
9917Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
9918@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
9919@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
9920and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
9921@end table
9922
c906108c
SS
9923Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
9924configuration):
c906108c
SS
9925
9926@table @code
9927@kindex target exec
9928@item target exec @var{program}
9929An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
9930@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
9931
c906108c
SS
9932@kindex target core
9933@item target core @var{filename}
9934A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
9935@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
9936
9937@kindex target remote
9938@item target remote @var{dev}
9939Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
9940specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
9941@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 9942supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
9943some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
9944it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
9945
c906108c
SS
9946@kindex target sim
9947@item target sim
2df3850c 9948Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213 9949In general,
474c8240 9950@smallexample
104c1213
JM
9951 target sim
9952 load
9953 run
474c8240 9954@end smallexample
d4f3574e 9955@noindent
104c1213 9956works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 9957drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
9958provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
9959see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
9960Processors}.
9961
c906108c
SS
9962@end table
9963
104c1213 9964Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
9965
9966@table @code
9967
c906108c
SS
9968@kindex target nrom
9969@item target nrom @var{dev}
9970NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
9971
c906108c
SS
9972@end table
9973
5d161b24 9974Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
c906108c 9975your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
9976
9977Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
9978once you've successfully established a connection.
9979
9980@table @code
9981
9982@kindex load @var{filename}
9983@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
9984Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
9985@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
9986is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
9987on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
9988@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
9989the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9990
9991If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
9992execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
9993target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
9994
9995The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
9996For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
9997link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
9998specifies a fixed address.
9999@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
10000
c906108c
SS
10001@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10002@end table
10003
6d2ebf8b 10004@node Byte Order
c906108c 10005@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 10006
c906108c
SS
10007@cindex choosing target byte order
10008@cindex target byte order
c906108c
SS
10009
10010Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
10011offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
10012orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
10013designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
10014which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 10015@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
10016
10017@table @code
10018@kindex set endian big
10019@item set endian big
10020Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
10021
10022@kindex set endian little
10023@item set endian little
10024Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
10025
10026@kindex set endian auto
10027@item set endian auto
10028Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
10029executable.
10030
10031@item show endian
10032Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
10033
10034@end table
10035
10036Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
10037data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
10038target system.
10039
6d2ebf8b 10040@node Remote
c906108c
SS
10041@section Remote debugging
10042@cindex remote debugging
10043
10044If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
5d161b24
DB
10045@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
10046For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
c906108c
SS
10047or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
10048powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
10049
10050Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
10051to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
5d161b24 10052@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
c906108c
SS
10053but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
10054write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
10055communicate with @value{GDBN}.
10056
10057Other remote targets may be available in your
10058configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 10059
6f05cf9f
AC
10060@node KOD
10061@section Kernel Object Display
10062
10063@cindex kernel object display
10064@cindex kernel object
10065@cindex KOD
10066
10067Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10068@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10069and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10070mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10071displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10072
10073Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10074@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10075
474c8240 10076@smallexample
6f05cf9f 10077(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
474c8240 10078@end smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10079
10080If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10081about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10082which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10083after the operating system:
c906108c 10084
474c8240 10085@smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10086(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
10087List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10088Object Description
10089any Any and all objects
474c8240 10090@end smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10091
10092Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10093by the kernel.
10094
10095There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
10096is supported other than to try it.
10097
10098
10099@node Remote Debugging
10100@chapter Debugging remote programs
10101
6b2f586d
AC
10102@menu
10103* Server:: Using the gdbserver program
10104* NetWare:: Using the gdbserve.nlm program
10105* remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
6b2f586d
AC
10106@end menu
10107
6f05cf9f
AC
10108@node Server
10109@section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10110
10111@kindex gdbserver
10112@cindex remote connection without stubs
10113@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10114allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10115@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10116
10117@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10118because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10119that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10120@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10121@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10122because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10123also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10124started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10125Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10126the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10127do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10128by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10129choice for debugging.
10130
10131@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10132or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10133protocol.
10134
10135@table @emph
10136@item On the target machine,
10137you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10138@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10139strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10140system does all the symbol handling.
10141
10142To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
56460a61 10143the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
6f05cf9f
AC
10144syntax is:
10145
10146@smallexample
10147target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10148@end smallexample
10149
10150@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10151hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10152@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10153@file{/dev/com1}:
10154
10155@smallexample
10156target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10157@end smallexample
10158
10159@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10160with it.
10161
10162To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10163
10164@smallexample
10165target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10166@end smallexample
10167
10168The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10169specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10170TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10171expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10172(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10173you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10174TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10175reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10176conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
10177and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
10178@code{target remote} command.
10179
56460a61
DJ
10180On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
10181This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
10182
10183@smallexample
10184target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
10185@end smallexample
10186
10187@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
10188to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
10189
6f05cf9f
AC
10190@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10191you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10192symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10193using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10194(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10195running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
10196remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
10197is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
10198@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
10199@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
10200
10201@smallexample
10202(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10203@end smallexample
10204
10205@noindent
10206communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10207
10208@smallexample
10209(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10210@end smallexample
10211
10212@noindent
10213communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10214For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10215the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10216text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10217@samp{Connection refused}.
10218@end table
10219
10220@node NetWare
10221@section Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10222
10223@kindex gdbserve.nlm
10224@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10225allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10226@code{target remote}.
10227
10228@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10229using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10230
10231@table @emph
10232@item On the target machine,
10233you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10234@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10235can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10236host system does all the symbol handling.
10237
10238To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10239@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10240program. The syntax is:
10241
10242@smallexample
10243load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10244 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10245@end smallexample
10246
10247@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10248the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
10249to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
10250
10251For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
10252communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
10253using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
10254
10255@smallexample
10256load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10257@end smallexample
10258
10259@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10260you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10261symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10262using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10263(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10264running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
10265remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
10266argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10267@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
10268
10269@smallexample
10270(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10271@end smallexample
10272
10273@noindent
10274communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10275@end table
10276
10277@node remote stub
10278@section Implementing a remote stub
7a292a7a 10279
8e04817f
AC
10280@cindex debugging stub, example
10281@cindex remote stub, example
10282@cindex stub example, remote debugging
10283The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
10284communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
10285@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
10286these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
10287implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
10288with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
10289organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
10290
104c1213
JM
10291@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
10292To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
10293@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
10294prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
10295program, you need:
c906108c 10296
104c1213
JM
10297@enumerate
10298@item
10299A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
10300have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
10301your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 10302
5d161b24 10303@item
d4f3574e 10304A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 10305subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 10306
104c1213
JM
10307@item
10308A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
10309download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
10310manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
10311documentation.
10312@end enumerate
96baa820 10313
104c1213
JM
10314The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
10315communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
10316machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 10317
104c1213
JM
10318@table @emph
10319@item On the host,
10320@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
10321else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
10322(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
10323
10324@item On the target,
10325you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
10326implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
10327subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
10328
10329On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
10330@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
10331@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
10332@end table
96baa820 10333
104c1213
JM
10334The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
10335machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
10336@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 10337
104c1213
JM
10338@cindex remote serial stub list
10339These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 10340
104c1213
JM
10341@table @code
10342
10343@item i386-stub.c
41afff9a 10344@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10345@cindex Intel
10346@cindex i386
10347For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
10348
10349@item m68k-stub.c
41afff9a 10350@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10351@cindex Motorola 680x0
10352@cindex m680x0
10353For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
10354
10355@item sh-stub.c
41afff9a 10356@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10357@cindex Hitachi
10358@cindex SH
10359For Hitachi SH architectures.
10360
10361@item sparc-stub.c
41afff9a 10362@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10363@cindex Sparc
10364For @sc{sparc} architectures.
10365
10366@item sparcl-stub.c
41afff9a 10367@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10368@cindex Fujitsu
10369@cindex SparcLite
10370For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
10371
10372@end table
10373
10374The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
10375recently added stubs.
10376
10377@menu
10378* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
10379* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
10380* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
10381@end menu
10382
6d2ebf8b 10383@node Stub Contents
6f05cf9f 10384@subsection What the stub can do for you
104c1213
JM
10385
10386@cindex remote serial stub
10387The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
10388subroutines:
10389
10390@table @code
10391@item set_debug_traps
10392@kindex set_debug_traps
10393@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
10394This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
10395program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
10396beginning of your program.
10397
10398@item handle_exception
10399@kindex handle_exception
10400@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
10401This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
10402explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
10403run when a trap is triggered.
10404
10405@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
10406execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
10407with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
10408protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 10409representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
10410information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
10411retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
10412execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
10413@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
5d161b24 10414machine.
104c1213
JM
10415
10416@item breakpoint
10417@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
10418Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
10419breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
10420way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
10421machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
10422pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
10423@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
10424simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
10425again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
10426your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
5d161b24 10427@value{GDBN} session gets control.
104c1213
JM
10428
10429Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
10430to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
10431start of your debugging session.
10432@end table
10433
6d2ebf8b 10434@node Bootstrapping
6f05cf9f 10435@subsection What you must do for the stub
104c1213
JM
10436
10437@cindex remote stub, support routines
10438The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
10439chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
10440debugging target machine.
10441
10442First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
10443serial port.
10444
10445@table @code
10446@item int getDebugChar()
10447@kindex getDebugChar
10448Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
10449It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
10450different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10451
10452@item void putDebugChar(int)
10453@kindex putDebugChar
10454Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
5d161b24 10455It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
104c1213
JM
10456different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10457@end table
10458
10459@cindex control C, and remote debugging
10460@cindex interrupting remote targets
10461If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
10462running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
10463for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
10464character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
10465remote system to stop.
10466
10467Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
10468probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
10469is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
10470@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
10471
10472Other routines you need to supply are:
10473
10474@table @code
10475@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
10476@kindex exceptionHandler
10477Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
10478handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
10479way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
10480are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
10481containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
10482@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
10483its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
10484might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
10485exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
10486@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
10487and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
10488you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
10489should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
10490
10491For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
10492gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
10493should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
10494@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
10495help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
10496
10497@item void flush_i_cache()
10498@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 10499On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
10500instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
10501instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
10502
10503On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
10504function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
10505@end table
10506
10507@noindent
10508You must also make sure this library routine is available:
10509
10510@table @code
10511@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
10512@kindex memset
10513This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
10514memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
10515@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
10516either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
10517@end table
10518
10519If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
10520library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
10521but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 10522subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
10523
10524
6d2ebf8b 10525@node Debug Session
6f05cf9f 10526@subsection Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
10527
10528@cindex remote serial debugging summary
10529In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
10530steps.
10531
10532@enumerate
10533@item
6d2ebf8b 10534Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
104c1213
JM
10535(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
10536@display
10537@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
10538@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
10539@end display
10540
10541@item
10542Insert these lines near the top of your program:
10543
474c8240 10544@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10545set_debug_traps();
10546breakpoint();
474c8240 10547@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10548
10549@item
10550For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
10551@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
10552
474c8240 10553@smallexample
104c1213 10554void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
474c8240 10555@end smallexample
104c1213 10556
d4f3574e 10557@noindent
104c1213 10558but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
598ca718 10559function in your program, that function is called when
104c1213
JM
10560@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
10561error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
10562one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
10563
10564@item
10565Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
10566your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
10567
10568@item
10569Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
10570the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
10571
10572@item
10573@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
10574@c document that. FIXME.
10575Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
10576whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
10577
10578@item
10579To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
10580as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
10581This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
10582of its pure text.
10583
d4f3574e 10584@item
104c1213 10585@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 10586Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
10587Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
10588machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
9db8d71f 10589TCP or UDP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
104c1213
JM
10590to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
10591device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
10592
474c8240 10593@smallexample
104c1213 10594target remote /dev/ttyb
474c8240 10595@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10596
10597@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
10598To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
9db8d71f
DJ
10599@code{@var{host}:@var{port}} or @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}.
10600For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
104c1213
JM
10601terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10602
474c8240 10603@smallexample
104c1213 10604target remote manyfarms:2828
474c8240 10605@end smallexample
a2bea4c3
CV
10606
10607If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
10608your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
10609the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
10610to port 1234 on your local machine:
10611
474c8240 10612@smallexample
a2bea4c3 10613target remote :1234
474c8240 10614@end smallexample
a2bea4c3
CV
10615@noindent
10616
10617Note that the colon is still required here.
9db8d71f
DJ
10618
10619@cindex UDP port, @code{target remote}
10620To use a UDP connection, use an argument of the form
10621@code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}. For example, to connect to UDP port 2828
10622on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10623
10624@smallexample
10625target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
10626@end smallexample
10627
10628When using a UDP connection for remote debugging, you should keep in mind
10629that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. UDP can silently drop packets on
10630busy or unreliable networks, which will cause havoc with your debugging
10631session.
10632
104c1213
JM
10633@end enumerate
10634
10635Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
10636step and continue the remote program.
10637
10638To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
10639command.
10640
10641@cindex interrupting remote programs
10642@cindex remote programs, interrupting
10643Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
10644interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
10645program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
10646and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
10647interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
10648
474c8240 10649@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10650Interrupted while waiting for the program.
10651Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
474c8240 10652@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10653
10654If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
10655(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
10656remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
10657goes back to waiting.
10658
104c1213 10659
8e04817f
AC
10660@node Configurations
10661@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
104c1213 10662
8e04817f
AC
10663While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
10664cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
10665describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
104c1213 10666
8e04817f
AC
10667There are three major categories of configurations: native
10668configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
10669operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
10670different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
10671are quite different from each other.
104c1213 10672
8e04817f
AC
10673@menu
10674* Native::
10675* Embedded OS::
10676* Embedded Processors::
10677* Architectures::
10678@end menu
104c1213 10679
8e04817f
AC
10680@node Native
10681@section Native
104c1213 10682
8e04817f
AC
10683This section describes details specific to particular native
10684configurations.
6cf7e474 10685
8e04817f
AC
10686@menu
10687* HP-UX:: HP-UX
10688* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
10689* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
78c47bea 10690* Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
8e04817f 10691@end menu
6cf7e474 10692
8e04817f
AC
10693@node HP-UX
10694@subsection HP-UX
104c1213 10695
8e04817f
AC
10696On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10697begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10698name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
104c1213 10699
8e04817f
AC
10700@node SVR4 Process Information
10701@subsection SVR4 process information
104c1213 10702
8e04817f
AC
10703@kindex /proc
10704@cindex process image
104c1213 10705
8e04817f
AC
10706Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10707used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10708subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10709this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10710several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10711@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10712@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
1104b9e7 10713and Unixware, but not HP-UX or @sc{gnu}/Linux, for example.
104c1213 10714
8e04817f
AC
10715@table @code
10716@kindex info proc
10717@item info proc
10718Summarize available information about the process.
6cf7e474 10719
8e04817f
AC
10720@kindex info proc mappings
10721@item info proc mappings
10722Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10723on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10724@ignore
10725@comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
10726@comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
10727@comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
10728@kindex info proc times
10729@item info proc times
10730Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
10731its children.
6cf7e474 10732
8e04817f
AC
10733@kindex info proc id
10734@item info proc id
10735Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
10736the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
104c1213 10737
8e04817f
AC
10738@kindex info proc status
10739@item info proc status
10740General information on the state of the process. If the process is
10741stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
10742received.
d4f3574e 10743
8e04817f
AC
10744@item info proc all
10745Show all the above information about the process.
10746@end ignore
10747@end table
104c1213 10748
8e04817f
AC
10749@node DJGPP Native
10750@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
10751@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
10752@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
10753@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
104c1213 10754
8e04817f
AC
10755@sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
10756MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
10757that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
10758top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
104c1213 10759
8e04817f
AC
10760@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
10761defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
10762subsection describes those commands.
104c1213 10763
8e04817f
AC
10764@table @code
10765@kindex info dos
10766@item info dos
10767This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
10768information about the target system and important OS structures.
f1251bdd 10769
8e04817f
AC
10770@kindex sysinfo
10771@cindex MS-DOS system info
10772@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
10773@item info dos sysinfo
10774This command displays assorted information about the underlying
10775platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
10776DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
104c1213 10777
8e04817f
AC
10778@cindex GDT
10779@cindex LDT
10780@cindex IDT
10781@cindex segment descriptor tables
10782@cindex descriptor tables display
10783@item info dos gdt
10784@itemx info dos ldt
10785@itemx info dos idt
10786These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
10787and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
10788tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
10789that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
10790descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
10791descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
10792rights.
104c1213 10793
8e04817f
AC
10794A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
10795segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
10796allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
10797conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
10798additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
d4f3574e 10799
8e04817f
AC
10800@cindex garbled pointers
10801These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
10802Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
10803displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
10804display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
10805example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
10806debugged program's data segment:
104c1213 10807
8e04817f
AC
10808@smallexample
10809@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
10810@exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
10811@end smallexample
104c1213 10812
8e04817f
AC
10813@noindent
10814This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
10815the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
104c1213 10816
8e04817f
AC
10817@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
10818@item info dos pde
10819@itemx info dos pte
10820These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
10821Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
10822data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
10823into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
10824page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
10825may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
10826Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
10827that is currently in use.
104c1213 10828
8e04817f
AC
10829Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
10830Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
10831the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
10832@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
10833Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
10834means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
10835the specified entry in the Page Directory.
104c1213 10836
8e04817f
AC
10837@cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
10838These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
10839Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
10840controller.
104c1213 10841
8e04817f 10842These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
104c1213 10843
8e04817f
AC
10844@cindex physical address from linear address
10845@item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
10846This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
10847address. The argument linear address @var{addr} should already have the
10848appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
10849accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
10850example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
10851the variable @code{i} is stored:
104c1213 10852
8e04817f
AC
10853@smallexample
10854@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
10855@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
10856@exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
10857@end smallexample
104c1213 10858
8e04817f
AC
10859@noindent
10860This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
10861whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
10862attributes of that page.
104c1213 10863
8e04817f
AC
10864Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
10865since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
10866address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
10867be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
10868declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
10869@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
104c1213 10870
8e04817f
AC
10871Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
10872transfer buffer:
104c1213 10873
8e04817f
AC
10874@smallexample
10875@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
10876@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
10877@exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
10878@end smallexample
104c1213 10879
8e04817f
AC
10880@noindent
10881(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
108823rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
10883this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
10884mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
104c1213 10885
8e04817f
AC
10886This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
10887@end table
104c1213 10888
78c47bea
PM
10889@node Cygwin Native
10890@subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
10891@cindex MS Windows debugging
10892@cindex native Cygwin debugging
10893@cindex Cygwin-specific commands
10894
10895@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, and
10896defines a few commands specific to the Cygwin port. This
10897subsection describes those commands.
10898
10899@table @code
10900@kindex info w32
10901@item info w32
10902This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
10903information about the target system and important OS structures.
10904
10905@item info w32 selector
10906This command displays information returned by
10907the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
10908It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
10909a long value to give the information about this given selector.
10910Without argument, this command displays information
10911about the the six segment registers.
10912
10913@kindex info dll
10914@item info dll
10915This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
10916
10917@kindex dll-symbols
10918@item dll-symbols
10919This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
10920add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
10921
10922@kindex set new-console
10923@item set new-console @var{mode}
10924If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
10925be started in a new console on next start.
10926If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
10927be started in the same console as the debugger.
10928
10929@kindex show new-console
10930@item show new-console
10931Displays whether a new console is used
10932when the debuggee is started.
10933
10934@kindex set new-group
10935@item set new-group @var{mode}
10936This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
10937start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
10938This affects the way the Windows OS handles
10939Ctrl-C.
10940
10941@kindex show new-group
10942@item show new-group
10943Displays current value of new-group boolean.
10944
10945@kindex set debugevents
10946@item set debugevents
10947This boolean value adds debug output concerning events seen by the debugger.
10948
10949@kindex set debugexec
10950@item set debugexec
10951This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
10952seen by the debugger.
10953
10954@kindex set debugexceptions
10955@item set debugexceptions
10956This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning exception events
10957seen by the debugger.
10958
10959@kindex set debugmemory
10960@item set debugmemory
10961This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning memory events
10962seen by the debugger.
10963
10964@kindex set shell
10965@item set shell
10966This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
10967via a shell or directly (default value is on).
10968
10969@kindex show shell
10970@item show shell
10971Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
10972
10973@end table
10974
8e04817f
AC
10975@node Embedded OS
10976@section Embedded Operating Systems
104c1213 10977
8e04817f
AC
10978This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
10979embedded operating systems that are available for several different
10980architectures.
d4f3574e 10981
8e04817f
AC
10982@menu
10983* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10984@end menu
104c1213 10985
8e04817f
AC
10986@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
10987various real-time operating systems.
104c1213 10988
8e04817f
AC
10989@node VxWorks
10990@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
104c1213 10991
8e04817f 10992@cindex VxWorks
104c1213 10993
8e04817f 10994@table @code
104c1213 10995
8e04817f
AC
10996@kindex target vxworks
10997@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
10998A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
10999is the target system's machine name or IP address.
104c1213 11000
8e04817f 11001@end table
104c1213 11002
8e04817f
AC
11003On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
11004current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
104c1213 11005
8e04817f
AC
11006@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
11007VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
11008the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11009both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
11010@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
11011installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
11012@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213 11013
8e04817f
AC
11014@table @code
11015@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
11016@kindex vxworks-timeout
11017All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
11018This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11019seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
11020your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
11021of a thin network line.
11022@end table
104c1213 11023
8e04817f
AC
11024The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
11025this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
11026procedures.
104c1213 11027
8e04817f
AC
11028@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
11029To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
11030to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
11031library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
11032VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
11033kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
11034source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
11035information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
11036manual.
11037@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
104c1213 11038
8e04817f
AC
11039Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
11040your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11041run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
11042@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 11043
8e04817f 11044@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
104c1213 11045
474c8240 11046@smallexample
8e04817f 11047(vxgdb)
474c8240 11048@end smallexample
104c1213 11049
8e04817f
AC
11050@menu
11051* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
11052* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
11053* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
11054@end menu
104c1213 11055
8e04817f
AC
11056@node VxWorks Connection
11057@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
104c1213 11058
8e04817f
AC
11059The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
11060network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
104c1213 11061
474c8240 11062@smallexample
8e04817f 11063(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
474c8240 11064@end smallexample
104c1213 11065
8e04817f
AC
11066@need 750
11067@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 11068
8e04817f
AC
11069@smallexample
11070Attaching remote machine across net...
11071Connected to tt.
11072@end smallexample
104c1213 11073
8e04817f
AC
11074@need 1000
11075@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
11076loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
11077these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
11078path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
11079to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
5d161b24 11080
474c8240 11081@smallexample
8e04817f 11082prog.o: No such file or directory.
474c8240 11083@end smallexample
104c1213 11084
8e04817f
AC
11085When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
11086the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
11087command again.
104c1213 11088
8e04817f
AC
11089@node VxWorks Download
11090@subsubsection VxWorks download
104c1213 11091
8e04817f
AC
11092@cindex download to VxWorks
11093If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
11094object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
11095@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
11096incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
11097command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
11098to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
11099table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
11100the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
11101filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
11102Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
11103to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
11104the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
11105@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
11106and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
11107program, type this on VxWorks:
104c1213 11108
474c8240 11109@smallexample
8e04817f 11110-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
474c8240 11111@end smallexample
104c1213 11112
8e04817f
AC
11113@noindent
11114Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 11115
474c8240 11116@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11117(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
11118(vxgdb) load prog.o
474c8240 11119@end smallexample
104c1213 11120
8e04817f 11121@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
104c1213 11122
8e04817f
AC
11123@smallexample
11124Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
11125@end smallexample
104c1213 11126
8e04817f
AC
11127You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
11128after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
11129this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
11130auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
11131history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
11132debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
11133table.)
104c1213 11134
8e04817f
AC
11135@node VxWorks Attach
11136@subsubsection Running tasks
104c1213
JM
11137
11138@cindex running VxWorks tasks
11139You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
11140follows:
11141
474c8240 11142@smallexample
104c1213 11143(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
474c8240 11144@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
11145
11146@noindent
11147where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
11148or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
11149the time of attachment.
11150
6d2ebf8b 11151@node Embedded Processors
104c1213
JM
11152@section Embedded Processors
11153
11154This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
11155configurations.
11156
7d86b5d5 11157
104c1213 11158@menu
104c1213
JM
11159* ARM:: ARM
11160* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
11161* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
11162* i960:: Intel i960
11163* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
11164* M68K:: Motorola M68K
104c1213 11165* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
a37295f9 11166* OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
104c1213
JM
11167* PA:: HP PA Embedded
11168* PowerPC: PowerPC
11169* SH:: Hitachi SH
11170* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
11171* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
11172* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
11173* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
11174@end menu
11175
6d2ebf8b 11176@node ARM
104c1213
JM
11177@subsection ARM
11178
11179@table @code
11180
8e04817f
AC
11181@kindex target rdi
11182@item target rdi @var{dev}
11183ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11184use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11185monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
11186
11187@kindex target rdp
11188@item target rdp @var{dev}
11189ARM Demon monitor.
11190
11191@end table
11192
11193@node H8/300
11194@subsection Hitachi H8/300
11195
11196@table @code
11197
11198@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
11199@item target hms @var{dev}
11200A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11201Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11202line and the communications speed used.
11203
11204@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
11205@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11206E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11207
11208@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11209@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
11210@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11211@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
11212Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11213
11214@end table
11215
11216@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11217@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11218@cindex download to Hitachi SH
11219@cindex Hitachi SH download
11220When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11221board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11222board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11223@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11224
11225@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
11226Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
11227
11228@enumerate
11229@item
11230that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11231for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11232emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
11233the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
11234H8/300, or H8/500.)
11235
11236@item
11237what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11238serial device available on your host is the default).
11239
11240@item
11241what speed to use over the serial device.
11242@end enumerate
11243
11244@menu
11245* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11246* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11247* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11248@end menu
11249
11250@node Hitachi Boards
11251@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11252
11253@c only for Unix hosts
11254@kindex device
11255@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
11256Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
11257need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11258first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11259hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11260
11261@kindex speed
11262@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
11263@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
11264speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
11265hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
11266the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11267@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
11268
11269The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11270use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11271use a DOS host,
11272@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11273called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11274through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11275to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11276
11277The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11278program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11279sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11280the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11281
11282First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11283board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11284port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11285When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
11286debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
11287for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11288@code{COM2}.
11289
474c8240 11290@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11291C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11292C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11293
11294Resident portion of MODE loaded
11295
11296COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11297
474c8240 11298@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11299
11300@quotation
11301@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11302@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11303disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11304your development board.
11305@end quotation
11306
11307@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
11308Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11309connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
11310the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
11311you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11312commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11313cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11314download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11315the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11316(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11317executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11318@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11319itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11320
11321@smallexample
11322(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
11323@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
11324 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
11325 the conditions.
11326There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
11327for details.
11328@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11329(@value{GDBP}) target hms
11330Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
11331(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
11332.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11333.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11334.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11335@end smallexample
11336
11337At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11338you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11339sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11340@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11341resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11342@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11343
11344Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11345available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11346you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11347
11348Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11349@itemize @bullet
11350@item
11351to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11352no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11353
11354@item
11355to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11356normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11357to detect program completion.
11358@end itemize
11359
11360In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11361development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11362
11363@node Hitachi ICE
11364@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11365
11366@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
11367You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11368Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11369e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11370
11371@table @code
11372@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11373Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11374@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11375@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11376(for example, @samp{9600}).
11377
11378@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11379If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11380specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11381@end table
11382
11383@node Hitachi Special
11384@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11385
11386Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11387
11388@table @code
11389
11390@kindex set machine
11391@kindex show machine
11392@item set machine h8300
11393@itemx set machine h8300h
11394Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11395architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11396to check which variant is currently in effect.
104c1213
JM
11397
11398@end table
11399
8e04817f
AC
11400@node H8/500
11401@subsection H8/500
104c1213
JM
11402
11403@table @code
11404
8e04817f
AC
11405@kindex set memory @var{mod}
11406@cindex memory models, H8/500
11407@item set memory @var{mod}
11408@itemx show memory
11409Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11410@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11411memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11412@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
104c1213 11413
8e04817f 11414@end table
104c1213 11415
8e04817f
AC
11416@node i960
11417@subsection Intel i960
104c1213 11418
8e04817f 11419@table @code
104c1213 11420
8e04817f
AC
11421@kindex target mon960
11422@item target mon960 @var{dev}
11423MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
104c1213 11424
8e04817f
AC
11425@kindex target nindy
11426@item target nindy @var{devicename}
11427An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
11428the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
11429@file{/dev/ttya}.
104c1213 11430
8e04817f
AC
11431@end table
11432
11433@cindex Nindy
11434@cindex i960
11435@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
11436@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
11437tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
11438
11439@itemize @bullet
104c1213 11440@item
8e04817f
AC
11441Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
11442Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
104c1213
JM
11443
11444@item
8e04817f 11445By responding to a prompt on startup;
104c1213
JM
11446
11447@item
8e04817f
AC
11448By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
11449session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
11450
11451@end itemize
11452
11453@cindex download to Nindy-960
11454With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
11455downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
11456@value{GDBN}.
11457
11458@menu
11459* Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
11460* Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
11461* Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
11462@end menu
11463
11464@node Nindy Startup
11465@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
11466
11467If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
11468options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
11469reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
11470
474c8240 11471@smallexample
8e04817f 11472Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
474c8240 11473@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11474
11475@noindent
11476Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
11477identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
11478simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
11479with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
11480use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
11481
11482@node Nindy Options
11483@subsubsection Options for Nindy
11484
11485These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
11486Nindy-960 board attached:
11487
11488@table @code
11489@item -r @var{port}
11490Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
11491to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
11492configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
11493@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
11494device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
11495suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
11496
11497@item -O
11498(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
11499the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
11500This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
11501target architecture.
11502
11503@quotation
11504@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
11505connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
11506fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
11507attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
11508this process with an interrupt.
11509@end quotation
11510
11511@item -brk
11512Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
11513system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
11514
11515@quotation
11516@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
11517requires; it only works with a few boards.
11518@end quotation
11519@end table
11520
11521The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
11522port.
11523
11524@c @group
11525@node Nindy Reset
11526@subsubsection Nindy reset command
11527
11528@table @code
11529@item reset
11530@kindex reset
11531For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
11532system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
11533circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
11534a break is detected.
11535@end table
11536@c @end group
11537
11538@node M32R/D
11539@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
11540
11541@table @code
11542
11543@kindex target m32r
11544@item target m32r @var{dev}
11545Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
11546
11547@end table
11548
11549@node M68K
11550@subsection M68k
11551
11552The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
11553target command for the following ROM monitors.
11554
11555@table @code
11556
11557@kindex target abug
11558@item target abug @var{dev}
11559ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
11560
11561@kindex target cpu32bug
11562@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
11563CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11564
11565@kindex target dbug
11566@item target dbug @var{dev}
11567dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
11568
11569@kindex target est
11570@item target est @var{dev}
11571EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11572
11573@kindex target rom68k
11574@item target rom68k @var{dev}
11575ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
11576
11577@end table
11578
11579If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
11580instead have only a single special target command:
11581
11582@table @code
11583
11584@kindex target es1800
11585@item target es1800 @var{dev}
11586ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
11587
11588@end table
11589
11590[context?]
11591
11592@table @code
11593
11594@kindex target rombug
11595@item target rombug @var{dev}
11596ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
11597
11598@end table
11599
8e04817f
AC
11600@node MIPS Embedded
11601@subsection MIPS Embedded
11602
11603@cindex MIPS boards
11604@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
11605MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
11606you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
104c1213 11607
8e04817f
AC
11608@need 1000
11609Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
104c1213 11610
8e04817f
AC
11611@table @code
11612@item target mips @var{port}
11613@kindex target mips @var{port}
11614To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
11615name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
11616command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
11617the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
11618been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
11619download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
104c1213 11620
8e04817f
AC
11621For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
11622port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
11623debugger:
104c1213 11624
474c8240 11625@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11626host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
11627@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
11628(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
11629(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
11630(@value{GDBP}) run
474c8240 11631@end smallexample
104c1213 11632
8e04817f
AC
11633@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
11634On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
11635connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
11636concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
11637@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 11638
8e04817f
AC
11639@item target pmon @var{port}
11640@kindex target pmon @var{port}
11641PMON ROM monitor.
104c1213 11642
8e04817f
AC
11643@item target ddb @var{port}
11644@kindex target ddb @var{port}
11645NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
104c1213 11646
8e04817f
AC
11647@item target lsi @var{port}
11648@kindex target lsi @var{port}
11649LSI variant of PMON.
104c1213 11650
8e04817f
AC
11651@kindex target r3900
11652@item target r3900 @var{dev}
11653Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
104c1213 11654
8e04817f
AC
11655@kindex target array
11656@item target array @var{dev}
11657Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
104c1213 11658
8e04817f 11659@end table
104c1213 11660
104c1213 11661
8e04817f
AC
11662@noindent
11663@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
104c1213 11664
8e04817f
AC
11665@table @code
11666@item set processor @var{args}
11667@itemx show processor
11668@kindex set processor @var{args}
11669@kindex show processor
11670Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11671processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
11672For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
11673to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
11674Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
11675is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
11676@value{GDBN} is using.
104c1213 11677
8e04817f
AC
11678@item set mipsfpu double
11679@itemx set mipsfpu single
11680@itemx set mipsfpu none
11681@itemx show mipsfpu
11682@kindex set mipsfpu
11683@kindex show mipsfpu
11684@cindex MIPS remote floating point
11685@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
11686If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
11687coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
11688need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
11689file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
11690functions which return floating point values. It also allows
11691@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
11692functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
11693with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
11694processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
11695double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
11696@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
104c1213 11697
8e04817f
AC
11698In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
11699floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
11700and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
104c1213 11701
8e04817f
AC
11702As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
11703@samp{show mipsfpu}.
104c1213 11704
8e04817f
AC
11705@item set remotedebug @var{n}
11706@itemx show remotedebug
11707@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11708@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11709@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
11710@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
11711@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
11712@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
11713You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
11714by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
11715@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
11716to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
11717at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
104c1213 11718
8e04817f
AC
11719@item set timeout @var{seconds}
11720@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
11721@itemx show timeout
11722@itemx show retransmit-timeout
11723@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
11724@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
11725@kindex set timeout
11726@kindex show timeout
11727@kindex set retransmit-timeout
11728@kindex show retransmit-timeout
11729You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
11730remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
11731default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
11732waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
11733retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
11734You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
11735retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
11736@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
104c1213 11737
8e04817f
AC
11738The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
11739is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
11740forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
11741to run before stopping.
11742@end table
104c1213 11743
a37295f9
MM
11744@node OpenRISC 1000
11745@subsection OpenRISC 1000
11746@cindex OpenRISC 1000
11747
11748@cindex or1k boards
11749See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
11750about platform and commands.
11751
11752@table @code
11753
11754@kindex target jtag
11755@item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
11756
11757Connects to remote JTAG server.
11758JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
11759connected via parallel port to the board.
11760
11761Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
11762
11763@kindex or1ksim
11764@item or1ksim @var{command}
11765If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
11766Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
11767
11768@kindex info or1k spr
11769@item info or1k spr
11770Displays spr groups.
11771
11772@item info or1k spr @var{group}
11773@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
11774Displays register names in selected group.
11775
11776@item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
11777@itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
11778@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
11779@itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
11780Shows information about specified spr register.
11781
11782@kindex spr
11783@item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
11784@itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
11785@itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
11786@itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
11787Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
11788@end table
11789
11790Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
11791It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
11792program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
11793triggers can be set using:
11794@table @code
11795@item $LEA/$LDATA
11796Load effective address/data
11797@item $SEA/$SDATA
11798Store effective address/data
11799@item $AEA/$ADATA
11800Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
11801@item $FETCH
11802Fetch data
11803@end table
11804
11805When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
11806@code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
11807
11808@code{htrace} commands:
11809@cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
11810@table @code
11811@kindex hwatch
11812@item hwatch @var{conditional}
11813Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effecive Address(es)
11814or Data. For example:
11815
11816@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
11817
11818@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
11819
11820@kindex htrace info
11821@item htrace info
11822Display information about current HW trace configuration.
11823
11824@kindex htrace trigger
11825@item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
11826Set starting criteria for HW trace.
11827
11828@kindex htrace qualifier
11829@item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
11830Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
11831
11832@kindex htrace stop
11833@item htrace stop @var{conditional}
11834Set HW trace stopping criteria.
11835
11836@kindex htrace record
11837@item htrace record @var{[data]*}
11838Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
11839triggered.
11840
11841@kindex htrace enable
11842@item htrace enable
11843@kindex htrace disable
11844@itemx htrace disable
11845Enables/disables the HW trace.
11846
11847@kindex htrace rewind
11848@item htrace rewind @var{[filename]}
11849Clears currently recorded trace data.
11850
11851If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
11852will be written there.
11853
11854@kindex htrace print
11855@item htrace print @var{[start [len]]}
11856Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
11857
11858@kindex htrace mode continuous
11859@item htrace mode continuous
11860Set continuous trace mode.
11861
11862@kindex htrace mode suspend
11863@item htrace mode suspend
11864Set suspend trace mode.
11865
11866@end table
11867
8e04817f
AC
11868@node PowerPC
11869@subsection PowerPC
104c1213
JM
11870
11871@table @code
104c1213 11872
8e04817f
AC
11873@kindex target dink32
11874@item target dink32 @var{dev}
11875DINK32 ROM monitor.
104c1213 11876
8e04817f
AC
11877@kindex target ppcbug
11878@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
11879@kindex target ppcbug1
11880@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
11881PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
104c1213 11882
8e04817f
AC
11883@kindex target sds
11884@item target sds @var{dev}
11885SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
11886
11887@end table
11888
11889@node PA
11890@subsection HP PA Embedded
104c1213
JM
11891
11892@table @code
11893
8e04817f
AC
11894@kindex target op50n
11895@item target op50n @var{dev}
11896OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
11897
11898@kindex target w89k
11899@item target w89k @var{dev}
11900W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
104c1213
JM
11901
11902@end table
11903
8e04817f
AC
11904@node SH
11905@subsection Hitachi SH
104c1213
JM
11906
11907@table @code
11908
8e04817f
AC
11909@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11910@item target hms @var{dev}
11911A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
11912commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
11913the communications speed used.
104c1213 11914
8e04817f
AC
11915@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11916@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11917E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
104c1213 11918
8e04817f
AC
11919@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
11920@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
11921@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11922@item target sh3e @var{dev}
11923Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
104c1213 11924
8e04817f 11925@end table
104c1213 11926
8e04817f
AC
11927@node Sparclet
11928@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
104c1213 11929
8e04817f
AC
11930@cindex Sparclet
11931
11932@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
11933Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
11934@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11935both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
11936@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213 11937
8e04817f
AC
11938@table @code
11939@item remotetimeout @var{args}
11940@kindex remotetimeout
11941@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
11942This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11943seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
104c1213
JM
11944@end table
11945
8e04817f
AC
11946@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
11947When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
11948information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
11949load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
11950@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213 11951
474c8240 11952@smallexample
8e04817f 11953sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
474c8240 11954@end smallexample
104c1213 11955
8e04817f 11956You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213 11957
474c8240 11958@smallexample
8e04817f 11959sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
474c8240 11960@end smallexample
104c1213 11961
8e04817f
AC
11962@cindex running, on Sparclet
11963Once you have set
11964your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11965run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
11966(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 11967
8e04817f
AC
11968@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11969
474c8240 11970@smallexample
8e04817f 11971(gdbslet)
474c8240 11972@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
11973
11974@menu
8e04817f
AC
11975* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
11976* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
11977* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
11978* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
104c1213
JM
11979@end menu
11980
8e04817f
AC
11981@node Sparclet File
11982@subsubsection Setting file to debug
104c1213 11983
8e04817f 11984The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
104c1213 11985
474c8240 11986@smallexample
8e04817f 11987(gdbslet) file prog
474c8240 11988@end smallexample
104c1213 11989
8e04817f
AC
11990@need 1000
11991@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
11992@value{GDBN} locates
11993the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
11994path.
11995If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
11996files will be searched as well.
11997@value{GDBN} locates
11998the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
11999path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
12000If it fails
12001to find a file, it displays a message such as:
104c1213 12002
474c8240 12003@smallexample
8e04817f 12004prog: No such file or directory.
474c8240 12005@end smallexample
104c1213 12006
8e04817f
AC
12007When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
12008the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
12009@code{target} command again.
104c1213 12010
8e04817f
AC
12011@node Sparclet Connection
12012@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
104c1213 12013
8e04817f
AC
12014The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
12015To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
104c1213 12016
474c8240 12017@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12018(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
12019Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
12020main () at ../prog.c:3
474c8240 12021@end smallexample
104c1213 12022
8e04817f
AC
12023@need 750
12024@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 12025
474c8240 12026@smallexample
8e04817f 12027Connected to ttya.
474c8240 12028@end smallexample
104c1213 12029
8e04817f
AC
12030@node Sparclet Download
12031@subsubsection Sparclet download
104c1213 12032
8e04817f
AC
12033@cindex download to Sparclet
12034Once connected to the Sparclet target,
12035you can use the @value{GDBN}
12036@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
12037The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
12038command.
12039Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
12040address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
12041offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
12042of each of the file's sections.
12043For instance, if the program
12044@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
12045and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 12046
474c8240 12047@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12048(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12049Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
474c8240 12050@end smallexample
104c1213 12051
8e04817f
AC
12052If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12053to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
12054to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12055
12056@node Sparclet Execution
12057@subsubsection Running and debugging
12058
12059@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12060You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
12061commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
12062manual for the list of commands.
12063
474c8240 12064@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12065(gdbslet) b main
12066Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
12067(gdbslet) run
12068Starting program: prog
12069Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
120703 char *symarg = 0;
12071(gdbslet) step
120724 char *execarg = "hello!";
12073(gdbslet)
474c8240 12074@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12075
12076@node Sparclite
12077@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
104c1213
JM
12078
12079@table @code
12080
8e04817f
AC
12081@kindex target sparclite
12082@item target sparclite @var{dev}
12083Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12084You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12085For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
12086remote protocol.
104c1213
JM
12087
12088@end table
12089
8e04817f
AC
12090@node ST2000
12091@subsection Tandem ST2000
104c1213 12092
8e04817f
AC
12093@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
12094STDBUG protocol.
104c1213 12095
8e04817f
AC
12096To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12097manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
104c1213 12098
474c8240 12099@smallexample
8e04817f 12100target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
474c8240 12101@end smallexample
104c1213 12102
8e04817f
AC
12103@noindent
12104to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12105the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12106ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12107connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12108concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 12109
8e04817f
AC
12110The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12111this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12112would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12113(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12114available on your host computer.
12115@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12116@c basically hearsay.
104c1213 12117
8e04817f
AC
12118@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12119These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12120environment:
104c1213 12121
8e04817f
AC
12122@table @code
12123@item st2000 @var{command}
12124@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12125@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12126@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12127Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12128manual for available commands.
104c1213 12129
8e04817f
AC
12130@item connect
12131@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12132Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12133you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12134sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12135@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12136@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
104c1213
JM
12137@end table
12138
8e04817f
AC
12139@node Z8000
12140@subsection Zilog Z8000
104c1213 12141
8e04817f
AC
12142@cindex Z8000
12143@cindex simulator, Z8000
12144@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
104c1213 12145
8e04817f
AC
12146When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12147a Z8000 simulator.
12148
12149For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12150unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12151segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12152appropriate by inspecting the object code.
104c1213 12153
8e04817f
AC
12154@table @code
12155@item target sim @var{args}
12156@kindex sim
12157@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
12158Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12159options, specify them via @var{args}.
104c1213
JM
12160@end table
12161
8e04817f
AC
12162@noindent
12163After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12164CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12165@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12166to run your program, and so on.
12167
12168As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12169(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12170additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
12171
12172@table @code
12173
8e04817f
AC
12174@item cycles
12175Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
104c1213 12176
8e04817f
AC
12177@item insts
12178Counts instructions run in the simulator.
104c1213 12179
8e04817f
AC
12180@item time
12181Execution time in 60ths of a second.
104c1213 12182
8e04817f 12183@end table
104c1213 12184
8e04817f
AC
12185You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12186conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12187conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12188simulated clock ticks.
104c1213 12189
8e04817f
AC
12190@node Architectures
12191@section Architectures
104c1213 12192
8e04817f
AC
12193This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
12194all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213 12195
8e04817f
AC
12196@menu
12197* A29K::
12198* Alpha::
12199* MIPS::
12200@end menu
104c1213 12201
8e04817f
AC
12202@node A29K
12203@subsection A29K
104c1213
JM
12204
12205@table @code
104c1213 12206
8e04817f
AC
12207@kindex set rstack_high_address
12208@cindex AMD 29K register stack
12209@cindex register stack, AMD29K
12210@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12211On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
12212@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
12213extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12214stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12215memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12216this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12217the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12218address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12219hexadecimal.
104c1213 12220
8e04817f
AC
12221@kindex show rstack_high_address
12222@item show rstack_high_address
12223Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12224processors.
104c1213 12225
8e04817f 12226@end table
104c1213 12227
8e04817f
AC
12228@node Alpha
12229@subsection Alpha
104c1213 12230
8e04817f 12231See the following section.
104c1213 12232
8e04817f
AC
12233@node MIPS
12234@subsection MIPS
104c1213 12235
8e04817f
AC
12236@cindex stack on Alpha
12237@cindex stack on MIPS
12238@cindex Alpha stack
12239@cindex MIPS stack
12240Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12241sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12242find the beginning of a function.
104c1213 12243
8e04817f
AC
12244@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12245To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12246@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12247you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12248commands:
104c1213 12249
8e04817f
AC
12250@table @code
12251@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
12252@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12253Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12254search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12255default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12256larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12257and therefore the longer it takes to run.
104c1213 12258
8e04817f
AC
12259@item show heuristic-fence-post
12260Display the current limit.
12261@end table
104c1213
JM
12262
12263@noindent
8e04817f
AC
12264These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12265for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
104c1213 12266
104c1213 12267
8e04817f
AC
12268@node Controlling GDB
12269@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12270
12271You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12272@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
12273data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
12274described here.
12275
12276@menu
12277* Prompt:: Prompt
12278* Editing:: Command editing
12279* History:: Command history
12280* Screen Size:: Screen size
12281* Numbers:: Numbers
1e698235 12282* ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
8e04817f
AC
12283* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
12284* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
12285@end menu
12286
12287@node Prompt
12288@section Prompt
104c1213 12289
8e04817f 12290@cindex prompt
104c1213 12291
8e04817f
AC
12292@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12293called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12294can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12295instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
12296the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
12297which one you are talking to.
104c1213 12298
8e04817f
AC
12299@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
12300prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12301or a prompt that does not.
104c1213 12302
8e04817f
AC
12303@table @code
12304@kindex set prompt
12305@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12306Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
104c1213 12307
8e04817f
AC
12308@kindex show prompt
12309@item show prompt
12310Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
104c1213
JM
12311@end table
12312
8e04817f
AC
12313@node Editing
12314@section Command editing
12315@cindex readline
12316@cindex command line editing
104c1213 12317
8e04817f
AC
12318@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12319@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12320command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12321or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12322substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12323debugging sessions.
104c1213 12324
8e04817f
AC
12325You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12326command @code{set}.
104c1213 12327
8e04817f
AC
12328@table @code
12329@kindex set editing
12330@cindex editing
12331@item set editing
12332@itemx set editing on
12333Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
104c1213 12334
8e04817f
AC
12335@item set editing off
12336Disable command line editing.
104c1213 12337
8e04817f
AC
12338@kindex show editing
12339@item show editing
12340Show whether command line editing is enabled.
104c1213
JM
12341@end table
12342
8e04817f
AC
12343@node History
12344@section Command history
12345
12346@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12347debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12348happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12349history facility.
104c1213
JM
12350
12351@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12352@cindex history substitution
12353@cindex history file
12354@kindex set history filename
12355@kindex GDBHISTFILE
12356@item set history filename @var{fname}
12357Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12358This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12359list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12360exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12361the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12362to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
12363@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12364is not set.
104c1213 12365
8e04817f
AC
12366@cindex history save
12367@kindex set history save
12368@item set history save
12369@itemx set history save on
12370Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12371@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
104c1213 12372
8e04817f
AC
12373@item set history save off
12374Stop recording command history in a file.
104c1213 12375
8e04817f
AC
12376@cindex history size
12377@kindex set history size
12378@item set history size @var{size}
12379Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12380This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12381@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
104c1213
JM
12382@end table
12383
8e04817f
AC
12384@cindex history expansion
12385History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12386@ifset have-readline-appendices
12387@xref{Event Designators}.
12388@end ifset
12389
12390Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12391is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12392@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12393follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12394a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12395history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12396@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12397
12398The commands to control history expansion are:
104c1213
JM
12399
12400@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12401@kindex set history expansion
12402@item set history expansion on
12403@itemx set history expansion
12404Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
104c1213 12405
8e04817f
AC
12406@item set history expansion off
12407Disable history expansion.
104c1213 12408
8e04817f
AC
12409The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12410editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12411or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12412@ifset have-readline-appendices
12413@xref{Command Line Editing}.
12414@end ifset
104c1213 12415
8e04817f
AC
12416@c @group
12417@kindex show history
12418@item show history
12419@itemx show history filename
12420@itemx show history save
12421@itemx show history size
12422@itemx show history expansion
12423These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12424@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12425@c @end group
12426@end table
12427
12428@table @code
12429@kindex shows
12430@item show commands
12431Display the last ten commands in the command history.
104c1213 12432
8e04817f
AC
12433@item show commands @var{n}
12434Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12435
12436@item show commands +
12437Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
104c1213
JM
12438@end table
12439
8e04817f
AC
12440@node Screen Size
12441@section Screen size
12442@cindex size of screen
12443@cindex pauses in output
104c1213 12444
8e04817f
AC
12445Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12446information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12447@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12448output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12449to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12450determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12451printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12452rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12453
12454Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12455driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
12456together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
12457@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
12458you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12459width} commands:
12460
12461@table @code
12462@kindex set height
12463@kindex set width
12464@kindex show width
12465@kindex show height
12466@item set height @var{lpp}
12467@itemx show height
12468@itemx set width @var{cpl}
12469@itemx show width
12470These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12471a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12472commands display the current settings.
104c1213 12473
8e04817f
AC
12474If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12475output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
12476file or to an editor buffer.
104c1213 12477
8e04817f
AC
12478Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12479from wrapping its output.
104c1213
JM
12480@end table
12481
8e04817f
AC
12482@node Numbers
12483@section Numbers
12484@cindex number representation
12485@cindex entering numbers
104c1213 12486
8e04817f
AC
12487You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12488@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12489@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12490begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12491default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12492numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12493change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12494radix} command.
104c1213 12495
8e04817f
AC
12496@table @code
12497@kindex set input-radix
12498@item set input-radix @var{base}
12499Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12500for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12501specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12502example, any of
104c1213 12503
8e04817f
AC
12504@smallexample
12505set radix 012
12506set radix 10.
12507set radix 0xa
12508@end smallexample
104c1213 12509
8e04817f
AC
12510@noindent
12511sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12512leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
104c1213 12513
8e04817f
AC
12514@kindex set output-radix
12515@item set output-radix @var{base}
12516Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12517for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12518specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
104c1213 12519
8e04817f
AC
12520@kindex show input-radix
12521@item show input-radix
12522Display the current default base for numeric input.
104c1213 12523
8e04817f
AC
12524@kindex show output-radix
12525@item show output-radix
12526Display the current default base for numeric display.
12527@end table
104c1213 12528
1e698235
DJ
12529@node ABI
12530@section Configuring the current ABI
12531
12532@value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
12533application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
12534conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
12535current ABI.
12536
98b45e30
DJ
12537@cindex OS ABI
12538@kindex set osabi
b4e9345d 12539@kindex show osabi
98b45e30
DJ
12540
12541One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
12542system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
12543@value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
12544but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
12545One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
12546an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
12547not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
12548platform provides.
12549
12550@table @code
12551@item show osabi
12552Show the OS ABI currently in use.
12553
12554@item set osabi
12555With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
12556
12557@item set osabi @var{abi}
12558Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
12559@end table
12560
1e698235
DJ
12561@cindex float promotion
12562@kindex set coerce-float-to-double
12563
12564Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
12565function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
12566(i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
12567according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
12568(i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
12569@code{double} and then passed.
12570
12571Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
12572a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
12573as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
12574
12575@table @code
12576@item set coerce-float-to-double
12577@itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
12578Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
12579to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
12580
12581@item set coerce-float-to-double off
12582Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
12583functions.
12584@end table
12585
8e04817f
AC
12586@node Messages/Warnings
12587@section Optional warnings and messages
104c1213 12588
8e04817f
AC
12589By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
12590running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12591command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12592internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
104c1213 12593
8e04817f
AC
12594Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12595which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12596see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
104c1213 12597
8e04817f
AC
12598@table @code
12599@kindex set verbose
12600@item set verbose on
12601Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 12602
8e04817f
AC
12603@item set verbose off
12604Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 12605
8e04817f
AC
12606@kindex show verbose
12607@item show verbose
12608Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12609@end table
104c1213 12610
8e04817f
AC
12611By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12612object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12613find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12614symbol files}).
104c1213 12615
8e04817f 12616@table @code
104c1213 12617
8e04817f
AC
12618@kindex set complaints
12619@item set complaints @var{limit}
12620Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12621unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
12622@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12623to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
104c1213 12624
8e04817f
AC
12625@kindex show complaints
12626@item show complaints
12627Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
104c1213 12628
8e04817f 12629@end table
104c1213 12630
8e04817f
AC
12631By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12632lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
12633you try to run a program which is already running:
104c1213 12634
474c8240 12635@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12636(@value{GDBP}) run
12637The program being debugged has been started already.
12638Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
474c8240 12639@end smallexample
104c1213 12640
8e04817f
AC
12641If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12642commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
104c1213 12643
8e04817f 12644@table @code
104c1213 12645
8e04817f
AC
12646@kindex set confirm
12647@cindex flinching
12648@cindex confirmation
12649@cindex stupid questions
12650@item set confirm off
12651Disables confirmation requests.
104c1213 12652
8e04817f
AC
12653@item set confirm on
12654Enables confirmation requests (the default).
104c1213 12655
8e04817f
AC
12656@kindex show confirm
12657@item show confirm
12658Displays state of confirmation requests.
12659
12660@end table
104c1213 12661
8e04817f
AC
12662@node Debugging Output
12663@section Optional messages about internal happenings
104c1213 12664@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12665@kindex set debug arch
12666@item set debug arch
12667Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
12668@kindex show debug arch
12669@item show debug arch
12670Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
12671@kindex set debug event
12672@item set debug event
12673Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
12674default is off.
12675@kindex show debug event
12676@item show debug event
12677Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
12678info.
12679@kindex set debug expression
12680@item set debug expression
12681Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
12682default is off.
12683@kindex show debug expression
12684@item show debug expression
12685Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
12686debugging info.
12687@kindex set debug overload
12688@item set debug overload
12689Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
12690info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
12691is off.
12692@kindex show debug overload
12693@item show debug overload
12694Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
12695debugging info.
12696@kindex set debug remote
12697@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
12698@cindex serial connections, debugging
12699@item set debug remote
12700Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
12701the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
12702@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
12703@kindex show debug remote
12704@item show debug remote
12705Displays the state of display of remote packets.
12706@kindex set debug serial
12707@item set debug serial
12708Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
12709default is off.
12710@kindex show debug serial
12711@item show debug serial
12712Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
12713info.
12714@kindex set debug target
12715@item set debug target
12716Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
12717includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
12718default is off.
12719@kindex show debug target
12720@item show debug target
12721Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
12722info.
12723@kindex set debug varobj
12724@item set debug varobj
12725Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
12726info. The default is off.
12727@kindex show debug varobj
12728@item show debug varobj
12729Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
12730debugging info.
12731@end table
104c1213 12732
8e04817f
AC
12733@node Sequences
12734@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
104c1213 12735
8e04817f
AC
12736Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
12737command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
12738commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
12739files.
104c1213 12740
8e04817f
AC
12741@menu
12742* Define:: User-defined commands
12743* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
12744* Command Files:: Command files
12745* Output:: Commands for controlled output
12746@end menu
104c1213 12747
8e04817f
AC
12748@node Define
12749@section User-defined commands
104c1213 12750
8e04817f
AC
12751@cindex user-defined command
12752A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
12753which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
12754@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
12755separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
12756via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
104c1213 12757
8e04817f
AC
12758@smallexample
12759define adder
12760 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
12761@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
12762
12763@noindent
8e04817f 12764To execute the command use:
104c1213 12765
8e04817f
AC
12766@smallexample
12767adder 1 2 3
12768@end smallexample
104c1213 12769
8e04817f
AC
12770@noindent
12771This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
12772its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
12773reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
12774functions calls.
104c1213
JM
12775
12776@table @code
104c1213 12777
8e04817f
AC
12778@kindex define
12779@item define @var{commandname}
12780Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
12781by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
104c1213 12782
8e04817f
AC
12783The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
12784which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
12785commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 12786
8e04817f
AC
12787@kindex if
12788@kindex else
12789@item if
12790Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
12791It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
12792only if the expression is true (nonzero).
12793There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
12794by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
12795was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 12796
8e04817f
AC
12797@kindex while
12798@item while
12799The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
12800which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
12801execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
12802The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
12803evaluates to true.
104c1213 12804
8e04817f
AC
12805@kindex document
12806@item document @var{commandname}
12807Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
12808accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
12809defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
12810reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
12811After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
12812@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
104c1213 12813
8e04817f
AC
12814You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
12815documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
12816does not change the documentation.
104c1213 12817
8e04817f
AC
12818@kindex help user-defined
12819@item help user-defined
12820List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
12821(if any) for each.
104c1213 12822
8e04817f
AC
12823@kindex show user
12824@item show user
12825@itemx show user @var{commandname}
12826Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
12827not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
12828definitions for all user-defined commands.
104c1213 12829
20f01a46
DH
12830@kindex show max-user-call-depth
12831@kindex set max-user-call-depth
12832@item show max-user-call-depth
5ca0cb28
DH
12833@itemx set max-user-call-depth
12834The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
12835levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
12836infinite recursion and aborts the command.
20f01a46 12837
104c1213
JM
12838@end table
12839
8e04817f
AC
12840When user-defined commands are executed, the
12841commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
12842stops execution of the user-defined command.
104c1213 12843
8e04817f
AC
12844If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
12845without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
12846commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
12847messages when used in a user-defined command.
104c1213 12848
8e04817f
AC
12849@node Hooks
12850@section User-defined command hooks
12851@cindex command hooks
12852@cindex hooks, for commands
12853@cindex hooks, pre-command
104c1213 12854
8e04817f
AC
12855@kindex hook
12856@kindex hook-
12857You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
12858command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
12859command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
12860before that command.
104c1213 12861
8e04817f
AC
12862@cindex hooks, post-command
12863@kindex hookpost
12864@kindex hookpost-
12865A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
12866Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
12867@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
12868that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
12869pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
104c1213 12870
8e04817f
AC
12871It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
12872occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
104c1213 12873
8e04817f
AC
12874@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
12875@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
104c1213 12876
8e04817f
AC
12877@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
12878In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
12879(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
12880execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
12881displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
104c1213 12882
8e04817f
AC
12883For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
12884single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
12885you could define:
104c1213 12886
474c8240 12887@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12888define hook-stop
12889handle SIGALRM nopass
12890end
104c1213 12891
8e04817f
AC
12892define hook-run
12893handle SIGALRM pass
12894end
104c1213 12895
8e04817f
AC
12896define hook-continue
12897handle SIGLARM pass
12898end
474c8240 12899@end smallexample
104c1213 12900
8e04817f
AC
12901As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
12902command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
12903you could define:
104c1213 12904
474c8240 12905@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12906define hook-echo
12907echo <<<---
12908end
104c1213 12909
8e04817f
AC
12910define hookpost-echo
12911echo --->>>\n
12912end
104c1213 12913
8e04817f
AC
12914(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
12915<<<---Hello World--->>>
12916(@value{GDBP})
104c1213 12917
474c8240 12918@end smallexample
104c1213 12919
8e04817f
AC
12920You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
12921not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
12922name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
12923@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
12924@c or not?
12925If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
12926@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
12927(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
104c1213 12928
8e04817f
AC
12929If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
12930get a warning from the @code{define} command.
c906108c 12931
8e04817f
AC
12932@node Command Files
12933@section Command files
c906108c 12934
8e04817f
AC
12935@cindex command files
12936A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
12937commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
12938An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
12939the last command, as it would from the terminal.
c906108c 12940
8e04817f
AC
12941@cindex init file
12942@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
12943@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
12944When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
12945@dfn{init files}, normally called @file{.gdbinit}@footnote{The DJGPP
12946port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini} instead, due to the
12947limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems.}.
12948During startup, @value{GDBN} does the following:
c906108c 12949
8e04817f
AC
12950@enumerate
12951@item
12952Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
12953DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
12954@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
c906108c 12955
8e04817f
AC
12956@item
12957Processes command line options and operands.
c906108c 12958
8e04817f
AC
12959@item
12960Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
c906108c 12961
8e04817f
AC
12962@item
12963Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
12964@end enumerate
c906108c 12965
8e04817f
AC
12966The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
12967complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
12968and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
12969option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
c906108c 12970
8e04817f
AC
12971@cindex init file name
12972On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
12973different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
12974form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
12975different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
12976environments with special init file names:
c906108c 12977
8e04817f
AC
12978@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
12979@itemize @bullet
12980@item
12981VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c 12982
8e04817f
AC
12983@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
12984@item
12985OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 12986
8e04817f
AC
12987@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
12988@item
12989ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
12990@end itemize
c906108c 12991
8e04817f
AC
12992You can also request the execution of a command file with the
12993@code{source} command:
c906108c 12994
8e04817f
AC
12995@table @code
12996@kindex source
12997@item source @var{filename}
12998Execute the command file @var{filename}.
c906108c
SS
12999@end table
13000
8e04817f 13001The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
a71ec265
DH
13002printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
13003execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
c906108c 13004
8e04817f
AC
13005Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
13006without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
13007normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
13008when called from command files.
c906108c 13009
8e04817f
AC
13010@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
13011mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
13012standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
13013not terminate execution of the command file --- execution continues with
13014the next command.
c906108c 13015
474c8240 13016@smallexample
8e04817f 13017gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
474c8240 13018@end smallexample
c906108c 13019
8e04817f
AC
13020(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
13021will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
13022would be directed to @file{log}.
c906108c 13023
8e04817f
AC
13024@node Output
13025@section Commands for controlled output
c906108c 13026
8e04817f
AC
13027During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
13028@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
13029explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
13030describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
13031want.
c906108c
SS
13032
13033@table @code
8e04817f
AC
13034@kindex echo
13035@item echo @var{text}
13036@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
13037@c because it is not in ANSI.
13038Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
13039@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
13040newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
13041In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
13042by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
13043string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
13044trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
13045To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
13046@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
c906108c 13047
8e04817f
AC
13048A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
13049the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
c906108c 13050
474c8240 13051@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13052echo This is some text\n\
13053which is continued\n\
13054onto several lines.\n
474c8240 13055@end smallexample
c906108c 13056
8e04817f 13057produces the same output as
c906108c 13058
474c8240 13059@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13060echo This is some text\n
13061echo which is continued\n
13062echo onto several lines.\n
474c8240 13063@end smallexample
c906108c 13064
8e04817f
AC
13065@kindex output
13066@item output @var{expression}
13067Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
13068newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
13069value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
13070on expressions.
c906108c 13071
8e04817f
AC
13072@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
13073Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
13074the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
13075formats}, for more information.
c906108c 13076
8e04817f
AC
13077@kindex printf
13078@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
13079Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
13080@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
13081either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
13082@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
13083subroutine
13084@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
13085@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
13086@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
13087@c supported.
c906108c 13088
474c8240 13089@smallexample
8e04817f 13090printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
474c8240 13091@end smallexample
c906108c 13092
8e04817f 13093For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
c906108c 13094
8e04817f
AC
13095@smallexample
13096printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
13097@end smallexample
c906108c 13098
8e04817f
AC
13099The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
13100string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
13101letter.
c906108c
SS
13102@end table
13103
8e04817f
AC
13104@node TUI
13105@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
13106@cindex TUI
c906108c 13107
8e04817f
AC
13108@menu
13109* TUI Overview:: TUI overview
13110* TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
7cf36c78 13111* TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
8e04817f
AC
13112* TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
13113* TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
13114@end menu
c906108c 13115
8e04817f
AC
13116The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short,
13117is a terminal interface which uses the @code{curses} library
13118to show the source file, the assembly output, the program registers
13119and @value{GDBN} commands in separate text windows.
13120The TUI is available only when @value{GDBN} is configured
13121with the @code{--enable-tui} configure option (@pxref{Configure Options}).
c906108c 13122
8e04817f
AC
13123@node TUI Overview
13124@section TUI overview
c906108c 13125
8e04817f
AC
13126The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
13127@value{GDBN} runs:
c906108c 13128
8e04817f
AC
13129@itemize @bullet
13130@item
13131A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
13132windows on the terminal.
c906108c 13133
8e04817f
AC
13134@item
13135A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
13136the TUI.
13137@end itemize
c906108c 13138
8e04817f
AC
13139In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
13140on the terminal:
c906108c 13141
8e04817f
AC
13142@table @emph
13143@item command
13144This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
13145prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
13146managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
13147window is always visible.
c906108c 13148
8e04817f
AC
13149@item source
13150The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
13151line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
c906108c 13152
8e04817f
AC
13153@item assembly
13154The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
c906108c 13155
8e04817f
AC
13156@item register
13157This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
13158a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
13159changed are highlighted.
c906108c 13160
c906108c
SS
13161@end table
13162
269c21fe
SC
13163The source and assembly windows show the current program position
13164by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
13165Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
13166indicates the breakpoint type:
13167
13168@table @code
13169@item B
13170Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13171
13172@item b
13173Breakpoint which was never hit.
13174
13175@item H
13176Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13177
13178@item h
13179Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
13180
13181@end table
13182
13183The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
13184
13185@table @code
13186@item +
13187Breakpoint is enabled.
13188
13189@item -
13190Breakpoint is disabled.
13191
13192@end table
13193
8e04817f
AC
13194The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
13195and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
13196changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
13197These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
13198layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
13199The following layouts are available:
c906108c 13200
8e04817f
AC
13201@itemize @bullet
13202@item
13203source
2df3850c 13204
8e04817f
AC
13205@item
13206assembly
13207
13208@item
13209source and assembly
13210
13211@item
13212source and registers
c906108c 13213
8e04817f
AC
13214@item
13215assembly and registers
2df3850c 13216
8e04817f 13217@end itemize
c906108c 13218
b7bb15bc
SC
13219On top of the command window a status line gives various information
13220concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
13221updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
13222are displayed:
13223
13224@table @emph
13225@item target
13226Indicates the current gdb target
13227(@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13228
13229@item process
13230Gives information about the current process or thread number.
13231When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
13232
13233@item function
13234Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
13235The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
13236When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
13237the string @code{??} is displayed.
13238
13239@item line
13240Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
13241When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
13242
13243@item pc
13244Indicates the current program counter address.
13245
13246@end table
13247
8e04817f
AC
13248@node TUI Keys
13249@section TUI Key Bindings
13250@cindex TUI key bindings
c906108c 13251
8e04817f
AC
13252The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
13253(@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
13254They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
7cf36c78
SC
13255directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
13256a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
13257@value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
8e04817f 13258are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
c906108c 13259
8e04817f
AC
13260@table @kbd
13261@kindex C-x C-a
13262@item C-x C-a
13263@kindex C-x a
13264@itemx C-x a
13265@kindex C-x A
13266@itemx C-x A
13267Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
13268the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
13269its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
13270mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
13271The screen is then refreshed.
c906108c 13272
8e04817f
AC
13273@kindex C-x 1
13274@item C-x 1
13275Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
13276either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
13277is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
2df3850c 13278
8e04817f 13279Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
c906108c 13280
8e04817f
AC
13281@kindex C-x 2
13282@item C-x 2
13283Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
13284layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
13285When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
13286previous layout and the new one.
c906108c 13287
8e04817f 13288Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
2df3850c 13289
7cf36c78
SC
13290@kindex C-x s
13291@item C-x s
13292Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
13293(@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
13294
c906108c
SS
13295@end table
13296
8e04817f 13297The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
5d161b24 13298
8e04817f
AC
13299@table @key
13300@kindex PgUp
13301@item PgUp
13302Scroll the active window one page up.
c906108c 13303
8e04817f
AC
13304@kindex PgDn
13305@item PgDn
13306Scroll the active window one page down.
c906108c 13307
8e04817f
AC
13308@kindex Up
13309@item Up
13310Scroll the active window one line up.
c906108c 13311
8e04817f
AC
13312@kindex Down
13313@item Down
13314Scroll the active window one line down.
c906108c 13315
8e04817f
AC
13316@kindex Left
13317@item Left
13318Scroll the active window one column left.
c906108c 13319
8e04817f
AC
13320@kindex Right
13321@item Right
13322Scroll the active window one column right.
c906108c 13323
8e04817f
AC
13324@kindex C-L
13325@item C-L
13326Refresh the screen.
c906108c 13327
8e04817f 13328@end table
c906108c 13329
8e04817f
AC
13330In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
13331for scrolling. This means they are not available for readline. It is
13332necessary to use other readline key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n},
13333@key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
13334
7cf36c78
SC
13335@node TUI Single Key Mode
13336@section TUI Single Key Mode
13337@cindex TUI single key mode
13338
13339The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
13340key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
13341some gdb commands.
13342
13343@table @kbd
13344@kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13345@item c
13346continue
13347
13348@kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13349@item d
13350down
13351
13352@kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13353@item f
13354finish
13355
13356@kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13357@item n
13358next
13359
13360@kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13361@item q
13362exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
13363
13364@kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13365@item r
13366run
13367
13368@kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13369@item s
13370step
13371
13372@kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13373@item u
13374up
13375
13376@kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13377@item v
13378info locals
13379
13380@kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13381@item w
13382where
13383
13384@end table
13385
13386Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
13387The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
13388it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
13389with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
13390@emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
13391this mode is by hitting @key{q} or @samp{@key{C-x} @key{s}}.
13392
13393
8e04817f
AC
13394@node TUI Commands
13395@section TUI specific commands
13396@cindex TUI commands
13397
13398The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
13399These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
13400the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
13401is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
13402in the TUI mode.
c906108c
SS
13403
13404@table @code
3d757584
SC
13405@item info win
13406@kindex info win
13407List and give the size of all displayed windows.
13408
8e04817f
AC
13409@item layout next
13410@kindex layout next
13411Display the next layout.
2df3850c 13412
8e04817f
AC
13413@item layout prev
13414@kindex layout prev
13415Display the previous layout.
c906108c 13416
8e04817f
AC
13417@item layout src
13418@kindex layout src
13419Display the source window only.
c906108c 13420
8e04817f
AC
13421@item layout asm
13422@kindex layout asm
13423Display the assembly window only.
c906108c 13424
8e04817f
AC
13425@item layout split
13426@kindex layout split
13427Display the source and assembly window.
c906108c 13428
8e04817f
AC
13429@item layout regs
13430@kindex layout regs
13431Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
13432
13433@item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
13434@kindex focus
13435Set the focus to the named window.
13436This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
13437can be affected to another window.
c906108c 13438
8e04817f
AC
13439@item refresh
13440@kindex refresh
13441Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
c906108c 13442
8e04817f
AC
13443@item update
13444@kindex update
13445Update the source window and the current execution point.
c906108c 13446
8e04817f
AC
13447@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
13448@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
13449@kindex winheight
13450Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
13451lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
13452decrease it.
2df3850c 13453
c906108c
SS
13454@end table
13455
8e04817f
AC
13456@node TUI Configuration
13457@section TUI configuration variables
13458@cindex TUI configuration variables
c906108c 13459
8e04817f
AC
13460The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
13461appearance of windows on the terminal.
c906108c 13462
8e04817f
AC
13463@table @code
13464@item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
13465@kindex set tui border-kind
13466Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
13467The possible values are the following:
13468@table @code
13469@item space
13470Use a space character to draw the border.
c906108c 13471
8e04817f
AC
13472@item ascii
13473Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
c906108c 13474
8e04817f
AC
13475@item acs
13476Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
13477drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
c78b4128 13478
8e04817f 13479@end table
c78b4128 13480
8e04817f
AC
13481@item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
13482@kindex set tui active-border-mode
13483Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
13484The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
13485@code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
c78b4128 13486
8e04817f
AC
13487@item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
13488@kindex set tui border-mode
13489Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
13490The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
13491@table @code
13492@item normal
13493Use normal attributes to display the border.
c906108c 13494
8e04817f
AC
13495@item standout
13496Use standout mode.
c906108c 13497
8e04817f
AC
13498@item reverse
13499Use reverse video mode.
c906108c 13500
8e04817f
AC
13501@item half
13502Use half bright mode.
c906108c 13503
8e04817f
AC
13504@item half-standout
13505Use half bright and standout mode.
c906108c 13506
8e04817f
AC
13507@item bold
13508Use extra bright or bold mode.
c78b4128 13509
8e04817f
AC
13510@item bold-standout
13511Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
c78b4128 13512
8e04817f 13513@end table
c78b4128 13514
8e04817f 13515@end table
c78b4128 13516
8e04817f
AC
13517@node Emacs
13518@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
c78b4128 13519
8e04817f
AC
13520@cindex Emacs
13521@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
13522A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
13523edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
13524@value{GDBN}.
c906108c 13525
8e04817f
AC
13526To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
13527executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
13528@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
13529created Emacs buffer.
13530@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c 13531
8e04817f
AC
13532Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
13533things:
c906108c 13534
8e04817f
AC
13535@itemize @bullet
13536@item
13537All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
13538@end itemize
c906108c 13539
8e04817f
AC
13540This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
13541and output done by the program you are debugging.
bf0184be 13542
8e04817f
AC
13543This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
13544commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
13545in this way.
bf0184be 13546
8e04817f
AC
13547All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
13548with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
13549way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
13550stop.
bf0184be 13551
8e04817f 13552@itemize @bullet
bf0184be 13553@item
8e04817f
AC
13554@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
13555@end itemize
bf0184be 13556
8e04817f
AC
13557Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
13558source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
13559left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
13560source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
13561and the source.
bf0184be 13562
8e04817f
AC
13563Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
13564usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
c906108c 13565
8e04817f
AC
13566@quotation
13567@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
13568current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
13569the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
13570appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
13571environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
13572session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
13573back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
13574avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
13575your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
13576@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
c906108c 13577
8e04817f
AC
13578A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
13579switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
13580@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
13581@end quotation
13582
13583By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
13584you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
13585several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
13586Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
13587
474c8240 13588@smallexample
8e04817f 13589(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
474c8240 13590@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13591
13592@noindent
13593(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
13594in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
13595``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
13596
13597In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
13598addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
c906108c 13599
8e04817f
AC
13600@table @kbd
13601@item C-h m
13602Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
c906108c 13603
8e04817f
AC
13604@item M-s
13605Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
13606update the display window to show the current file and location.
c906108c 13607
8e04817f
AC
13608@item M-n
13609Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
13610calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
13611to show the current file and location.
c906108c 13612
8e04817f
AC
13613@item M-i
13614Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
13615display window accordingly.
c906108c 13616
8e04817f
AC
13617@item M-x gdb-nexti
13618Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
13619display window accordingly.
c906108c 13620
8e04817f
AC
13621@item C-c C-f
13622Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
13623@code{finish} command.
c906108c 13624
8e04817f
AC
13625@item M-c
13626Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
13627command.
b433d00b 13628
8e04817f 13629@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
b433d00b 13630
8e04817f
AC
13631@item M-u
13632Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
13633(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
13634like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
b433d00b 13635
8e04817f 13636@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
c906108c 13637
8e04817f
AC
13638@item M-d
13639Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
13640@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
c906108c 13641
8e04817f 13642@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
c906108c 13643
8e04817f
AC
13644@item C-x &
13645Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
13646of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
13647around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
13648then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
13649argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
c906108c 13650
8e04817f
AC
13651You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
13652@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
13653otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
13654inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
13655wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
13656list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
13657formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
13658is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
13659@end table
c906108c 13660
8e04817f
AC
13661In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
13662tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
c906108c 13663
8e04817f
AC
13664If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
13665it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
13666request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
13667the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
13668frame.
c906108c 13669
8e04817f
AC
13670The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
13671which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
13672the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
13673communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
13674delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
13675to correspond properly with the code.
c906108c 13676
8e04817f
AC
13677@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
13678@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
13679@ignore
13680@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
13681@kindex Epoch
13682@kindex inspect
c906108c 13683
8e04817f
AC
13684Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
13685called the @code{epoch}
13686environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
13687@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
13688each value is printed in its own window.
13689@end ignore
c906108c 13690
8e04817f
AC
13691@include annotate.texi
13692@include gdbmi.texinfo
c906108c 13693
8e04817f
AC
13694@node GDB Bugs
13695@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
13696@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
13697@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 13698
8e04817f 13699Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
c906108c 13700
8e04817f
AC
13701Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
13702may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
13703the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
13704reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 13705
8e04817f
AC
13706In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
13707information that enables us to fix the bug.
c4555f82
SC
13708
13709@menu
8e04817f
AC
13710* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
13711* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
c4555f82
SC
13712@end menu
13713
8e04817f
AC
13714@node Bug Criteria
13715@section Have you found a bug?
13716@cindex bug criteria
c4555f82 13717
8e04817f 13718If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
c4555f82
SC
13719
13720@itemize @bullet
8e04817f
AC
13721@cindex fatal signal
13722@cindex debugger crash
13723@cindex crash of debugger
c4555f82 13724@item
8e04817f
AC
13725If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
13726@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
13727
13728@cindex error on valid input
13729@item
13730If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
13731bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
13732somewhere in the connection to the target.)
c4555f82 13733
8e04817f 13734@cindex invalid input
c4555f82 13735@item
8e04817f
AC
13736If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
13737that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
13738``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
13739for traditional practice''.
13740
13741@item
13742If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
13743for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
c4555f82
SC
13744@end itemize
13745
8e04817f
AC
13746@node Bug Reporting
13747@section How to report bugs
13748@cindex bug reports
13749@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
13750
13751A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
13752If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
13753contact that organization first.
13754
13755You can find contact information for many support companies and
13756individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
13757distribution.
13758@c should add a web page ref...
13759
129188f6
AC
13760In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
13761@value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
13762@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
13763page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
13764be used.
8e04817f
AC
13765
13766@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
13767@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
13768not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
13769@samp{bug-gdb}.
13770
13771The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
13772serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
13773the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
13774newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
13775problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
13776path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
13777we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
13778bug reports to the mailing list.
c4555f82 13779
8e04817f
AC
13780The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
13781@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
13782fact or leave it out, state it!
c4555f82 13783
8e04817f
AC
13784Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
13785problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
13786assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
13787Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
13788stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
13789name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
13790of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
13791the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
13792easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
c4555f82 13793
8e04817f
AC
13794Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
13795bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
13796you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
13797self-contained.
c4555f82 13798
8e04817f
AC
13799Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
13800bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
13801@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
13802bugs properly.
13803
13804To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
c4555f82
SC
13805
13806@itemize @bullet
13807@item
8e04817f
AC
13808The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
13809with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
13810version}.
c4555f82 13811
8e04817f
AC
13812Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
13813the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
c4555f82
SC
13814
13815@item
8e04817f
AC
13816The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
13817version number.
c4555f82
SC
13818
13819@item
8e04817f
AC
13820What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
13821``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c4555f82
SC
13822
13823@item
8e04817f
AC
13824What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
13825debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
13826C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
13827information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
13828compilers.
c4555f82 13829
8e04817f
AC
13830@item
13831The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
13832observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
13833you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
13834Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
c4555f82 13835
8e04817f
AC
13836If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
13837and then we might not encounter the bug.
c4555f82 13838
8e04817f
AC
13839@item
13840A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
13841reproduce the bug.
c4555f82 13842
8e04817f
AC
13843@item
13844A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
13845incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
c4555f82 13846
8e04817f
AC
13847Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
13848will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
13849not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
13850a chance to make a mistake.
c4555f82 13851
8e04817f
AC
13852Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
13853say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
13854copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
13855the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
13856crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
13857ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
13858us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
13859to draw any conclusion from our observations.
c4555f82 13860
8e04817f
AC
13861@item
13862If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
13863diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
13864it by context, not by line number.
c4555f82 13865
8e04817f
AC
13866The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
13867sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
c4555f82 13868
8e04817f 13869@end itemize
c4555f82 13870
8e04817f 13871Here are some things that are not necessary:
c4555f82 13872
8e04817f
AC
13873@itemize @bullet
13874@item
13875A description of the envelope of the bug.
c4555f82 13876
8e04817f
AC
13877Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
13878which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
13879changes will not affect it.
c4555f82 13880
8e04817f
AC
13881This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
13882will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
13883with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
13884We recommend that you save your time for something else.
c4555f82 13885
8e04817f
AC
13886Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
13887of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
13888output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
13889less time, and so on.
c4555f82 13890
8e04817f
AC
13891However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
13892report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
c4555f82 13893
8e04817f
AC
13894@item
13895A patch for the bug.
c4555f82 13896
8e04817f
AC
13897A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
13898the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
13899a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
13900to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
c4555f82 13901
8e04817f
AC
13902Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
13903construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
13904through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
13905to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
c4555f82 13906
8e04817f
AC
13907And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
13908patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
13909help us to understand.
c4555f82 13910
8e04817f
AC
13911@item
13912A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
c4555f82 13913
8e04817f
AC
13914Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
13915things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
13916@end itemize
c4555f82 13917
8e04817f
AC
13918@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
13919@c and consists of the two following files:
13920@c rluser.texinfo
13921@c inc-hist.texinfo
13922@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
13923@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
13924@include rluser.texinfo
13925@include inc-hist.texinfo
c4555f82 13926
c4555f82 13927
8e04817f
AC
13928@node Formatting Documentation
13929@appendix Formatting Documentation
c4555f82 13930
8e04817f
AC
13931@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
13932@cindex reference card
13933The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
13934for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
13935subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
13936@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
13937release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
13938you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
c4555f82 13939
8e04817f
AC
13940The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
13941can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
c4555f82 13942
474c8240 13943@smallexample
8e04817f 13944make refcard.dvi
474c8240 13945@end smallexample
c4555f82 13946
8e04817f
AC
13947The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
13948mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
13949that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
13950high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
13951your @sc{dvi} output program.
c4555f82 13952
8e04817f 13953@cindex documentation
c4555f82 13954
8e04817f
AC
13955All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
13956distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
13957a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
13958on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
13959formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
13960and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
c4555f82 13961
8e04817f
AC
13962@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
13963version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
13964file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
13965subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
13966necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
13967but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
13968Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
13969@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
c4555f82 13970
8e04817f
AC
13971If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
13972Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
13973@code{makeinfo}.
c4555f82 13974
8e04817f
AC
13975If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
13976@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
13977version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
c4555f82 13978
474c8240 13979@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13980cd gdb
13981make gdb.info
474c8240 13982@end smallexample
c4555f82 13983
8e04817f
AC
13984If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
13985a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
13986Texinfo definitions file.
c4555f82 13987
8e04817f
AC
13988@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
13989produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
13990document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
13991has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
13992command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
13993(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
13994require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
c4555f82 13995
8e04817f
AC
13996@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
13997@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
13998written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
13999typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
14000and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
14001directory.
c4555f82 14002
8e04817f
AC
14003If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
14004typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
14005subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
14006@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
c4555f82 14007
474c8240 14008@smallexample
8e04817f 14009make gdb.dvi
474c8240 14010@end smallexample
c4555f82 14011
8e04817f 14012Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c4555f82 14013
8e04817f
AC
14014@node Installing GDB
14015@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
14016@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
14017@cindex installation
c4555f82 14018
8e04817f
AC
14019@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
14020of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
14021build the @code{gdb} program.
14022@iftex
14023@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
14024@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
14025look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
14026installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
14027@end iftex
c4555f82 14028
8e04817f
AC
14029The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
14030@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
14031appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
c4555f82 14032
8e04817f
AC
14033For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
14034@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
c4555f82 14035
8e04817f
AC
14036@table @code
14037@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
14038script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
c4555f82 14039
8e04817f
AC
14040@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
14041the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
c4555f82 14042
8e04817f
AC
14043@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
14044source for the Binary File Descriptor library
c906108c 14045
8e04817f
AC
14046@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
14047@sc{gnu} include files
c906108c 14048
8e04817f
AC
14049@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
14050source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
c906108c 14051
8e04817f
AC
14052@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
14053source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
c906108c 14054
8e04817f
AC
14055@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
14056source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
c906108c 14057
8e04817f
AC
14058@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
14059source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
c906108c 14060
8e04817f
AC
14061@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
14062source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
14063@end table
c906108c 14064
8e04817f
AC
14065The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
14066from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
14067this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
c906108c 14068
8e04817f
AC
14069First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
14070if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
14071identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
14072argument.
c906108c 14073
8e04817f 14074For example:
c906108c 14075
474c8240 14076@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14077cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14078./configure @var{host}
14079make
474c8240 14080@end smallexample
c906108c 14081
8e04817f
AC
14082@noindent
14083where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
14084@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
14085(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
14086correct value by examining your system.)
c906108c 14087
8e04817f
AC
14088Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
14089@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
14090libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
14091binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
c906108c 14092
8e04817f
AC
14093@need 750
14094@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
14095system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
14096shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
c906108c 14097
474c8240 14098@smallexample
8e04817f 14099sh configure @var{host}
474c8240 14100@end smallexample
c906108c 14101
8e04817f
AC
14102If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
14103directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
14104@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
14105creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
14106you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
14107
14108You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
14109subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
14110configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
c906108c 14111
8e04817f
AC
14112For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
14113the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
c906108c 14114
474c8240 14115@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14116@group
14117cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
14118../configure @var{host}
14119@end group
474c8240 14120@end smallexample
c906108c 14121
8e04817f
AC
14122You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
14123However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
14124the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
14125that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
14126let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
c906108c 14127
8e04817f
AC
14128@menu
14129* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
14130* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
14131* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
14132@end menu
c906108c 14133
8e04817f
AC
14134@node Separate Objdir
14135@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
c906108c 14136
8e04817f
AC
14137If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
14138you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
14139host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
14140allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
14141rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
14142handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
14143@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
14144program specified there.
c906108c 14145
8e04817f
AC
14146To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
14147with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
14148(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
14149itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
14150would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
14151the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
c906108c 14152
8e04817f
AC
14153For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
14154separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
c906108c 14155
474c8240 14156@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14157@group
14158cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14159mkdir ../gdb-sun4
14160cd ../gdb-sun4
14161../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
14162make
14163@end group
474c8240 14164@end smallexample
c906108c 14165
8e04817f
AC
14166When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
14167directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
14168(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
14169the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
14170directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
14171@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
c906108c 14172
8e04817f
AC
14173One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
14174directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
14175@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
14176programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
14177You specify a cross-debugging target by
14178giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
c906108c 14179
8e04817f
AC
14180When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
14181it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
14182called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
c906108c 14183
8e04817f
AC
14184The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
14185directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
14186directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
14187directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
14188will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
c906108c 14189
8e04817f
AC
14190When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
14191directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
14192if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
14193with each other.
c906108c 14194
8e04817f
AC
14195@node Config Names
14196@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
c906108c 14197
8e04817f
AC
14198The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
14199script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
14200aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
14201of information in the following pattern:
c906108c 14202
474c8240 14203@smallexample
8e04817f 14204@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
474c8240 14205@end smallexample
c906108c 14206
8e04817f
AC
14207For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
14208or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
14209option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
c906108c 14210
8e04817f
AC
14211The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
14212any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
14213aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
14214@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
14215script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
14216abbreviations---for example:
c906108c 14217
8e04817f
AC
14218@smallexample
14219% sh config.sub i386-linux
14220i386-pc-linux-gnu
14221% sh config.sub alpha-linux
14222alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
14223% sh config.sub hp9k700
14224hppa1.1-hp-hpux
14225% sh config.sub sun4
14226sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
14227% sh config.sub sun3
14228m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
14229% sh config.sub i986v
14230Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
14231@end smallexample
c906108c 14232
8e04817f
AC
14233@noindent
14234@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
14235directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
d700128c 14236
8e04817f
AC
14237@node Configure Options
14238@section @code{configure} options
c906108c 14239
8e04817f
AC
14240Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
14241are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
14242several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
14243Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
c906108c 14244
474c8240 14245@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14246configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
14247 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14248 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14249 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
14250 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
14251 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
14252 @var{host}
474c8240 14253@end smallexample
c906108c 14254
8e04817f
AC
14255@noindent
14256You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
14257@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
14258@samp{--}.
c906108c 14259
8e04817f
AC
14260@table @code
14261@item --help
14262Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
c906108c 14263
8e04817f
AC
14264@item --prefix=@var{dir}
14265Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
14266@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 14267
8e04817f
AC
14268@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
14269Configure the source to install programs under directory
14270@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 14271
8e04817f
AC
14272@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
14273@need 2000
14274@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
14275@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
14276@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
14277Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
14278@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
14279build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
14280directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
14281the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
14282directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
14283the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
14284@var{dirname}.
c906108c 14285
8e04817f
AC
14286@item --norecursion
14287Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
14288propagate configuration to subdirectories.
c906108c 14289
8e04817f
AC
14290@item --target=@var{target}
14291Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
14292@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
14293programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
c906108c 14294
8e04817f 14295There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
c906108c 14296
8e04817f
AC
14297@item @var{host} @dots{}
14298Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
c906108c 14299
8e04817f
AC
14300There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
14301@end table
c906108c 14302
8e04817f
AC
14303There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
14304needed for special purposes only.
c906108c 14305
8e04817f
AC
14306@node Maintenance Commands
14307@appendix Maintenance Commands
14308@cindex maintenance commands
14309@cindex internal commands
c906108c 14310
8e04817f
AC
14311In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
14312includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers.
14313These commands are provided here for reference.
c906108c 14314
8e04817f
AC
14315@table @code
14316@kindex maint info breakpoints
14317@item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
14318Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
14319breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
14320internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
14321breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
14322is shown:
c906108c 14323
8e04817f
AC
14324@table @code
14325@item breakpoint
14326Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
c906108c 14327
8e04817f
AC
14328@item watchpoint
14329Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
c906108c 14330
8e04817f
AC
14331@item longjmp
14332Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
14333@code{longjmp} calls.
c906108c 14334
8e04817f
AC
14335@item longjmp resume
14336Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
c906108c 14337
8e04817f
AC
14338@item until
14339Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
c906108c 14340
8e04817f
AC
14341@item finish
14342Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
c906108c 14343
8e04817f
AC
14344@item shlib events
14345Shared library events.
c906108c 14346
8e04817f 14347@end table
c906108c 14348
8d30a00d
AC
14349@kindex maint internal-error
14350@kindex maint internal-warning
14351@item maint internal-error
14352@itemx maint internal-warning
14353Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
14354or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
14355or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
14356internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
14357either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
14358@value{GDBN} session.
14359
14360@smallexample
14361(gdb) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
14362@dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
14363A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
14364debugging may prove unreliable.
14365Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
14366Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
14367(gdb)
14368@end smallexample
14369
14370Takes an optional parameter that is used as the text of the error or
14371warning message.
14372
0680b120
AC
14373@kindex maint print registers
14374@kindex maint print raw-registers
14375@kindex maint print cooked-registers
14376@item maint print registers
14377@itemx maint print raw-registers
14378@itemx maint print cooked-registers
14379Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
14380
14381The command @samp{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
14382the raw register cache; and the command @samp{maint print
14383cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers.
14384@xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint, @value{GDBN} Internals}.
14385
14386Takes an optional file parameter.
14387
8e04817f 14388@end table
c906108c 14389
c906108c 14390
e0ce93ac 14391@node Remote Protocol
8e04817f 14392@appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
c906108c 14393
ee2d5c50
AC
14394@menu
14395* Overview::
14396* Packets::
14397* Stop Reply Packets::
14398* General Query Packets::
14399* Register Packet Format::
14400* Examples::
14401@end menu
14402
14403@node Overview
14404@section Overview
14405
8e04817f
AC
14406There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
14407protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
14408machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
14409recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 14410
d2c6833e 14411In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
8e04817f 14412transmitted and received data respectfully.
c906108c 14413
8e04817f
AC
14414@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
14415@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
14416@cindex remote serial protocol
14417All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
14418sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
14419@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
14420@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
c906108c 14421
474c8240 14422@smallexample
8e04817f 14423@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
474c8240 14424@end smallexample
8e04817f 14425@noindent
c906108c 14426
8e04817f
AC
14427@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
14428@noindent
14429The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
14430characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
14431eight bit unsigned checksum).
c906108c 14432
8e04817f
AC
14433Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
14434specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
c906108c 14435
474c8240 14436@smallexample
8e04817f 14437@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
474c8240 14438@end smallexample
c906108c 14439
8e04817f
AC
14440@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
14441@noindent
14442That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
14443has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
14444since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
c906108c 14445
8e04817f
AC
14446@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
14447When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
14448response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
14449the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
14450retransmission):
c906108c 14451
474c8240 14452@smallexample
d2c6833e
AC
14453-> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14454<- @code{+}
474c8240 14455@end smallexample
8e04817f 14456@noindent
53a5351d 14457
8e04817f
AC
14458The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
14459debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
14460the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
14461when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
c906108c 14462
8e04817f
AC
14463@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
14464exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
14465exceptions).
c906108c 14466
8e04817f 14467Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
ee2d5c50 14468@cindex remote protocol, field separator
8e04817f 14469@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
ee2d5c50 14470@sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
c906108c 14471
8e04817f
AC
14472Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
14473@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
14474would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
c906108c 14475
8e04817f
AC
14476Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
14477means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
14478which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
14479@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
14480where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
14481characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
14482value greater than 126 should not be used.
c906108c 14483
8e04817f
AC
14484Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
14485loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
14486character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
c906108c 14487
8e04817f 14488So:
474c8240 14489@smallexample
8e04817f 14490"@code{0* }"
474c8240 14491@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14492@noindent
14493means the same as "0000".
c906108c 14494
8e04817f
AC
14495The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
14496error number. That number is not well defined.
c906108c 14497
8e04817f
AC
14498For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
14499(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
14500protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
14501on that response.
c906108c 14502
8e04817f
AC
14503A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
14504@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
14505optional.
c906108c 14506
ee2d5c50
AC
14507@node Packets
14508@section Packets
14509
14510The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
14511@var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
14512
14513@table @r
14514
14515@item @code{!} --- extended mode
14516@cindex @code{!} packet
14517
8e04817f
AC
14518Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
14519persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
14520debugged.
ee2d5c50
AC
14521
14522Reply:
14523@table @samp
14524@item OK
8e04817f 14525The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
ee2d5c50 14526@end table
c906108c 14527
ee2d5c50
AC
14528@item @code{?} --- last signal
14529@cindex @code{?} packet
c906108c 14530
ee2d5c50
AC
14531Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
14532step and continue.
c906108c 14533
ee2d5c50
AC
14534Reply:
14535@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14536
14537@item @code{a} --- reserved
14538
14539Reserved for future use.
14540
14541@item @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,@dots{}} --- set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
14542@cindex @code{A} packet
c906108c 14543
8e04817f
AC
14544Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
14545specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
ee2d5c50
AC
14546See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
14547
14548Reply:
14549@table @samp
14550@item OK
14551@item E@var{NN}
14552@end table
14553
14554@item @code{b}@var{baud} --- set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
14555@cindex @code{b} packet
14556
14557Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
14558
14559JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
14560received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
14561problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
14562
14563Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
14564it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
14565some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
14566switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
14567of view, nothing actually happened.}
14568
14569@item @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode} --- set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
14570@cindex @code{B} packet
14571
8e04817f 14572Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
2f870471
AC
14573breakpoint at @var{addr}.
14574
14575This packet has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets
14576(@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
c906108c 14577
ee2d5c50
AC
14578@item @code{c}@var{addr} --- continue
14579@cindex @code{c} packet
14580
14581@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
8e04817f 14582current address.
c906108c 14583
ee2d5c50
AC
14584Reply:
14585@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14586
14587@item @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- continue with signal
14588@cindex @code{C} packet
14589
8e04817f
AC
14590Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
14591@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
c906108c 14592
ee2d5c50
AC
14593Reply:
14594@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
c906108c 14595
ee2d5c50
AC
14596@item @code{d} --- toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
14597@cindex @code{d} packet
14598
14599Toggle debug flag.
14600
14601@item @code{D} --- detach
14602@cindex @code{D} packet
14603
14604Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
14605before @value{GDBN} disconnects.
14606
14607Reply:
14608@table @samp
14609@item @emph{no response}
8e04817f 14610@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
ee2d5c50 14611@end table
c906108c 14612
ee2d5c50 14613@item @code{e} --- reserved
c906108c 14614
ee2d5c50 14615Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14616
ee2d5c50 14617@item @code{E} --- reserved
c906108c 14618
ee2d5c50 14619Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14620
ee2d5c50
AC
14621@item @code{f} --- reserved
14622
14623Reserved for future use.
14624
14625@item @code{F} --- reserved
14626
14627Reserved for future use.
14628
14629@item @code{g} --- read registers
14630@anchor{read registers packet}
14631@cindex @code{g} packet
14632
14633Read general registers.
14634
14635Reply:
14636@table @samp
14637@item @var{XX@dots{}}
8e04817f
AC
14638Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
14639with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
14640each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
ee2d5c50
AC
14641determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}
14642and @var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
8e04817f 14643@code{g} packets is specified below.
ee2d5c50
AC
14644@item E@var{NN}
14645for an error.
14646@end table
c906108c 14647
ee2d5c50
AC
14648@item @code{G}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write regs
14649@cindex @code{G} packet
c906108c 14650
ee2d5c50
AC
14651@xref{read registers packet}, for a description of the @var{XX@dots{}}
14652data.
14653
14654Reply:
14655@table @samp
14656@item OK
14657for success
14658@item E@var{NN}
14659for an error
14660@end table
14661
14662@item @code{h} --- reserved
14663
14664Reserved for future use.
14665
14666@item @code{H}@var{c}@var{t@dots{}} --- set thread
14667@cindex @code{H} packet
c906108c 14668
8e04817f 14669Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
ee2d5c50
AC
14670@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
14671should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
14672operations. The thread designator @var{t@dots{}} may be -1, meaning all
14673the threads, a thread number, or zero which means pick any thread.
14674
14675Reply:
14676@table @samp
14677@item OK
14678for success
14679@item E@var{NN}
14680for an error
14681@end table
c906108c 14682
8e04817f
AC
14683@c FIXME: JTC:
14684@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
14685@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
14686@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
14687@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
14688@c described. For example:
14689@c
14690@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
14691@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
14692@c otherwise returns current registers.
14693@c
14694@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
14695@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
14696@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
c906108c 14697
ee2d5c50
AC
14698@item @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn} --- cycle step @strong{(draft)}
14699@anchor{cycle step packet}
14700@cindex @code{i} packet
14701
8e04817f
AC
14702Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
14703present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
14704step starting at that address.
c906108c 14705
ee2d5c50
AC
14706@item @code{I} --- signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
14707@cindex @code{I} packet
14708
14709@xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle step packet}.
14710
14711@item @code{j} --- reserved
14712
14713Reserved for future use.
14714
14715@item @code{J} --- reserved
c906108c 14716
ee2d5c50 14717Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14718
ee2d5c50
AC
14719@item @code{k} --- kill request
14720@cindex @code{k} packet
c906108c 14721
ac282366 14722FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
ee2d5c50
AC
14723thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
14724thread?)}.
c906108c 14725
ee2d5c50 14726@item @code{K} --- reserved
c906108c 14727
ee2d5c50
AC
14728Reserved for future use.
14729
14730@item @code{l} --- reserved
14731
14732Reserved for future use.
14733
14734@item @code{L} --- reserved
14735
14736Reserved for future use.
14737
14738@item @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- read memory
14739@cindex @code{m} packet
c906108c 14740
8e04817f 14741Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
ee2d5c50 14742Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are
2e834e49 14743assumed using word aligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
8e04817f 14744transfer mechanism is needed.}
c906108c 14745
ee2d5c50
AC
14746Reply:
14747@table @samp
14748@item @var{XX@dots{}}
14749@var{XX@dots{}} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
14750to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume
2e834e49 14751that sized memory transfers are assumed using word aligned
ee2d5c50
AC
14752accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is
14753needed.}
14754@item E@var{NN}
14755@var{NN} is errno
14756@end table
14757
14758@item @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem
14759@cindex @code{M} packet
14760
8e04817f 14761Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
ee2d5c50
AC
14762@var{XX@dots{}} is the data.
14763
14764Reply:
14765@table @samp
14766@item OK
14767for success
14768@item E@var{NN}
8e04817f
AC
14769for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
14770written).
ee2d5c50 14771@end table
c906108c 14772
ee2d5c50 14773@item @code{n} --- reserved
c906108c 14774
ee2d5c50 14775Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14776
ee2d5c50 14777@item @code{N} --- reserved
c906108c 14778
ee2d5c50 14779Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14780
ee2d5c50
AC
14781@item @code{o} --- reserved
14782
14783Reserved for future use.
14784
14785@item @code{O} --- reserved
14786
14787Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14788
ee2d5c50
AC
14789@item @code{p}@var{n@dots{}} --- read reg @strong{(reserved)}
14790@cindex @code{p} packet
14791
14792@xref{write register packet}.
14793
14794Reply:
14795@table @samp
14796@item @var{r@dots{}.}
14797The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
14798@end table
14799
14800@item @code{P}@var{n@dots{}}@code{=}@var{r@dots{}} --- write register
14801@anchor{write register packet}
14802@cindex @code{P} packet
14803
14804Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}, which contains two hex
8e04817f 14805digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
c906108c 14806
ee2d5c50
AC
14807Reply:
14808@table @samp
14809@item OK
14810for success
14811@item E@var{NN}
14812for an error
14813@end table
14814
14815@item @code{q}@var{query} --- general query
14816@anchor{general query packet}
14817@cindex @code{q} packet
14818
14819Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries have a
14820leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a company
14821prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may optionally
14822be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs must ensure
14823that they match the full @var{query} name.
14824
14825Reply:
14826@table @samp
14827@item @var{XX@dots{}}
14828Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
14829@item E@var{NN}
14830error reply
8e04817f 14831@item
ee2d5c50
AC
14832Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
14833@end table
14834
14835@item @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val} --- general set
14836@cindex @code{Q} packet
14837
14838Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}.
14839
14840@xref{general query packet}, for a discussion of naming conventions.
c906108c 14841
ee2d5c50
AC
14842@item @code{r} --- reset @strong{(deprecated)}
14843@cindex @code{r} packet
c906108c 14844
8e04817f 14845Reset the entire system.
c906108c 14846
ee2d5c50
AC
14847@item @code{R}@var{XX} --- remote restart
14848@cindex @code{R} packet
14849
8e04817f
AC
14850Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
14851This packet is only available in extended mode.
ee2d5c50
AC
14852
14853Reply:
14854@table @samp
14855@item @emph{no reply}
8e04817f 14856The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
ee2d5c50
AC
14857@end table
14858
14859@item @code{s}@var{addr} --- step
14860@cindex @code{s} packet
c906108c 14861
8e04817f
AC
14862@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
14863same address.
c906108c 14864
ee2d5c50
AC
14865Reply:
14866@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14867
14868@item @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- step with signal
14869@anchor{step with signal packet}
14870@cindex @code{S} packet
14871
8e04817f 14872Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
c906108c 14873
ee2d5c50
AC
14874Reply:
14875@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14876
14877@item @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM} --- search
14878@cindex @code{t} packet
14879
8e04817f 14880Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
ee2d5c50
AC
14881@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
14882@var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
c906108c 14883
ee2d5c50
AC
14884@item @code{T}@var{XX} --- thread alive
14885@cindex @code{T} packet
c906108c 14886
ee2d5c50 14887Find out if the thread XX is alive.
c906108c 14888
ee2d5c50
AC
14889Reply:
14890@table @samp
14891@item OK
14892thread is still alive
14893@item E@var{NN}
14894thread is dead
14895@end table
14896
14897@item @code{u} --- reserved
14898
14899Reserved for future use.
14900
14901@item @code{U} --- reserved
14902
14903Reserved for future use.
14904
14905@item @code{v} --- reserved
14906
14907Reserved for future use.
14908
14909@item @code{V} --- reserved
c906108c 14910
ee2d5c50 14911Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14912
ee2d5c50 14913@item @code{w} --- reserved
c906108c 14914
ee2d5c50 14915Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14916
ee2d5c50 14917@item @code{W} --- reserved
c906108c 14918
ee2d5c50 14919Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14920
ee2d5c50
AC
14921@item @code{x} --- reserved
14922
14923Reserved for future use.
14924
14925@item @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem (binary)
14926@cindex @code{X} packet
14927
14928@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX@dots{}}
14929is binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
8e04817f 14930escaped using @code{0x7d}.
c906108c 14931
ee2d5c50
AC
14932Reply:
14933@table @samp
14934@item OK
14935for success
14936@item E@var{NN}
14937for an error
14938@end table
14939
14940@item @code{y} --- reserved
c906108c 14941
ee2d5c50 14942Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14943
ee2d5c50
AC
14944@item @code{Y} reserved
14945
14946Reserved for future use.
14947
2f870471
AC
14948@item @code{z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
14949@itemx @code{Z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
14950@anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
ee2d5c50 14951@cindex @code{z} packet
2f870471 14952@cindex @code{Z} packets
ee2d5c50 14953
2f870471
AC
14954Insert (@code{Z}) or remove (@code{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
14955watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
14956@var{length} bytes.
ee2d5c50 14957
2f870471
AC
14958Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
14959separately.
14960
512217c7
AC
14961@emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
14962for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
14963remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
2f870471
AC
14964@code{Z}@var{type}@dots{} and @code{z}@var{type}@dots{} packet pair. To
14965avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
14966be implemented in an idempotent way.}
14967
14968@item @code{z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
14969@item @code{Z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
14970@cindex @code{z0} packet
14971@cindex @code{Z0} packet
14972
14973Insert (@code{Z0}) or remove (@code{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
14974@code{addr} of size @code{length}.
14975
14976A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
14977@var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
14978@code{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
14979breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
14980@sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
c906108c 14981
2f870471
AC
14982@emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
14983code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
14984overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
14985target, is not defined.}
c906108c 14986
ee2d5c50
AC
14987Reply:
14988@table @samp
2f870471
AC
14989@item OK
14990success
14991@item
14992not supported
ee2d5c50
AC
14993@item E@var{NN}
14994for an error
2f870471
AC
14995@end table
14996
14997@item @code{z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
14998@item @code{Z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
14999@cindex @code{z1} packet
15000@cindex @code{Z1} packet
15001
15002Insert (@code{Z1}) or remove (@code{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
15003address @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
15004
15005A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
15006dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
15007
15008@emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
15009movement.}
15010
15011Reply:
15012@table @samp
ee2d5c50 15013@item OK
2f870471
AC
15014success
15015@item
15016not supported
15017@item E@var{NN}
15018for an error
15019@end table
15020
15021@item @code{z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15022@item @code{Z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15023@cindex @code{z2} packet
15024@cindex @code{Z2} packet
15025
15026Insert (@code{Z2}) or remove (@code{z2}) a write watchpoint.
15027
15028Reply:
15029@table @samp
15030@item OK
15031success
15032@item
15033not supported
15034@item E@var{NN}
15035for an error
15036@end table
15037
15038@item @code{z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15039@item @code{Z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15040@cindex @code{z3} packet
15041@cindex @code{Z3} packet
15042
2e834e49 15043Insert (@code{Z3}) or remove (@code{z3}) a read watchpoint.
2f870471
AC
15044
15045Reply:
15046@table @samp
15047@item OK
15048success
15049@item
15050not supported
15051@item E@var{NN}
15052for an error
15053@end table
15054
2e834e49
HPN
15055@item @code{z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15056@item @code{Z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
2f870471
AC
15057@cindex @code{z4} packet
15058@cindex @code{Z4} packet
15059
15060Insert (@code{Z4}) or remove (@code{z4}) an access watchpoint.
15061
15062Reply:
15063@table @samp
15064@item OK
15065success
15066@item
15067not supported
15068@item E@var{NN}
15069for an error
ee2d5c50
AC
15070@end table
15071
15072@end table
c906108c 15073
ee2d5c50
AC
15074@node Stop Reply Packets
15075@section Stop Reply Packets
15076@cindex stop reply packets
c906108c 15077
8e04817f
AC
15078The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
15079receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
15080@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
15081when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
15082number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
15083conventions is used.
c906108c 15084
ee2d5c50 15085@table @samp
c906108c 15086
ee2d5c50
AC
15087@item S@var{AA}
15088@var{AA} is the signal number
c906108c 15089
8e04817f 15090@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
ee2d5c50
AC
15091@cindex @code{T} packet reply
15092
8e04817f
AC
15093@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
15094(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
15095by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
3c3bea1c
GS
15096thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = (@samp{watch} |
15097@samp{rwatch} | @samp{awatch}, @var{r...} = data address, this is a hex
15098integer; @var{n...} = other string not starting with valid hex digit.
15099@value{GDBN} should ignore this @var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on
15100to the next. This way we can extend the protocol.
c906108c 15101
ee2d5c50
AC
15102@item W@var{AA}
15103
8e04817f 15104The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
ee2d5c50
AC
15105applicable to certain targets.
15106
15107@item X@var{AA}
c906108c 15108
8e04817f 15109The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
c906108c 15110
ee2d5c50
AC
15111@item N@var{AA};@var{t@dots{}};@var{d@dots{}};@var{b@dots{}} @strong{(obsolete)}
15112
15113@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t@dots{}} = address of symbol
15114@code{_start}; @var{d@dots{}} = base of data section; @var{b@dots{}} =
15115base of bss section. @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets.
15116The difference between this reply and the @samp{qOffsets} query is that
15117the @samp{N} packet may arrive spontaneously whereas the @samp{qOffsets}
15118is a query initiated by the host debugger.}
c906108c 15119
ee2d5c50 15120@item O@var{XX@dots{}}
c906108c 15121
ee2d5c50
AC
15122@var{XX@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at
15123any time while the program is running and the debugger should continue
15124to wait for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
15125
15126@end table
15127
15128@node General Query Packets
15129@section General Query Packets
c906108c 15130
8e04817f 15131The following set and query packets have already been defined.
c906108c 15132
ee2d5c50 15133@table @r
c906108c 15134
ee2d5c50
AC
15135@item @code{q}@code{C} --- current thread
15136
15137Return the current thread id.
15138
15139Reply:
15140@table @samp
15141@item @code{QC}@var{pid}
8e04817f 15142Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
ee2d5c50
AC
15143@item *
15144Any other reply implies the old pid.
15145@end table
15146
15147@item @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} -- all thread ids
15148
15149@code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
c906108c 15150
8e04817f
AC
15151Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
15152may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
15153works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
15154obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
15155be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
15156sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
ee2d5c50
AC
15157
15158NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
15159
15160Reply:
15161@table @samp
15162@item @code{m}@var{id}
15163A single thread id
15164@item @code{m}@var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
15165a comma-separated list of thread ids
15166@item @code{l}
15167(lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
15168@end table
15169
15170In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
15171more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. @value{GDBN}
15172will respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
8e04817f
AC
15173@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
15174(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
c906108c 15175
ee2d5c50
AC
15176@item @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id} --- extra thread info
15177
15178Where @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. Obtain a printable
15179string description of a thread's attributes from the target OS. This
15180string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting for
15181@value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is displayed
15182in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display. Some examples of
15183possible thread extra info strings are ``Runnable'', or ``Blocked on
15184Mutex''.
15185
15186Reply:
15187@table @samp
15188@item @var{XX@dots{}}
15189Where @var{XX@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising
15190the printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
8e04817f 15191attributes.
ee2d5c50
AC
15192@end table
15193
15194@item @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread} --- query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
c906108c 15195
8e04817f
AC
15196Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
15197digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
15198subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
15199number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
15200(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
15201returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
ee2d5c50
AC
15202
15203NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} query
15204(see above).
15205
15206Reply:
15207@table @samp
15208@item @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread@dots{}}
8e04817f
AC
15209Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
15210returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
15211and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
ee2d5c50
AC
15212digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread@dots{}}
15213is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
8e04817f 15214digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
ee2d5c50 15215@end table
c906108c 15216
ee2d5c50
AC
15217@item @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- compute CRC of memory block
15218
15219Reply:
15220@table @samp
15221@item @code{E}@var{NN}
15222An error (such as memory fault)
15223@item @code{C}@var{CRC32}
15224A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
15225@end table
15226
15227@item @code{q}@code{Offsets} --- query sect offs
c906108c 15228
8e04817f
AC
15229Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
15230image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
15231response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
15232offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
c906108c 15233
ee2d5c50
AC
15234Reply:
15235@table @samp
15236@item @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
15237@end table
15238
15239@item @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid} --- thread info request
15240
8e04817f
AC
15241Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
15242encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
ee2d5c50
AC
15243
15244Reply:
15245@table @samp
15246@item *
15247@end table
15248
8e04817f 15249See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
c906108c 15250
ee2d5c50
AC
15251@item @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{command} --- remote command
15252
15253@var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
8e04817f
AC
15254execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
15255Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
ee2d5c50
AC
15256number of intermediate @code{O}@var{output} console output packets.
15257@emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a stubs's
15258interpreter may have security implications}.
15259
15260Reply:
15261@table @samp
15262@item OK
8e04817f 15263A command response with no output.
ee2d5c50 15264@item @var{OUTPUT}
8e04817f 15265A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
ee2d5c50 15266@item @code{E}@var{NN}
8e04817f 15267Indicate a badly formed request.
ee2d5c50 15268@item @samp{}
8e04817f 15269When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
ee2d5c50
AC
15270@end table
15271
15272@item @code{qSymbol::} --- symbol lookup
c906108c 15273
8e04817f
AC
15274Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
15275requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
15276
15277Reply:
15278@table @samp
15279@item @code{OK}
8e04817f 15280The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
15281@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
15282The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
15283@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
15284@code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} message, described below.
15285@end table
15286
15287@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} --- symbol value
15288
15289Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
15290
15291@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
15292target has previously requested.
15293
15294@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
15295@value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
15296will be empty.
15297
15298Reply:
15299@table @samp
15300@item @code{OK}
8e04817f 15301The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
15302@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
15303The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
15304encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
15305(if available), until the target ceases to request them.
15306@end table
eb12ee30 15307
ee2d5c50
AC
15308@end table
15309
15310@node Register Packet Format
15311@section Register Packet Format
eb12ee30 15312
8e04817f 15313The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
ee2d5c50
AC
15314In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
15315sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
15316to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target
15317byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered
15318most-significant - least-significant.
eb12ee30 15319
ee2d5c50 15320@table @r
eb12ee30 15321
8e04817f 15322@item MIPS32
ee2d5c50 15323
8e04817f
AC
15324All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
1532532 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
15326registers; fsr; fir; fp.
eb12ee30 15327
8e04817f 15328@item MIPS64
ee2d5c50 15329
8e04817f
AC
15330All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
15331thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
15332as @code{MIPS32}.
eb12ee30 15333
ee2d5c50
AC
15334@end table
15335
15336@node Examples
15337@section Examples
eb12ee30 15338
8e04817f
AC
15339Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
15340does not get any direct output:
eb12ee30 15341
474c8240 15342@smallexample
d2c6833e
AC
15343-> @code{R00}
15344<- @code{+}
8e04817f 15345@emph{target restarts}
d2c6833e 15346-> @code{?}
8e04817f 15347<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
15348<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
15349-> @code{+}
474c8240 15350@end smallexample
eb12ee30 15351
8e04817f 15352Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
eb12ee30 15353
474c8240 15354@smallexample
d2c6833e 15355-> @code{G1445@dots{}}
8e04817f 15356<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
15357-> @code{s}
15358<- @code{+}
15359@emph{time passes}
15360<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
8e04817f 15361-> @code{+}
d2c6833e 15362-> @code{g}
8e04817f 15363<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
15364<- @code{1455@dots{}}
15365-> @code{+}
474c8240 15366@end smallexample
eb12ee30 15367
aab4e0ec 15368@include gpl.texi
eb12ee30 15369
6826cf00
EZ
15370@include fdl.texi
15371
6d2ebf8b 15372@node Index
c906108c
SS
15373@unnumbered Index
15374
15375@printindex cp
15376
15377@tex
15378% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
15379% meantime:
15380\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
15381\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
15382\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
15383\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
15384\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
15385\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
15386\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
15387\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
15388\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
15389\page\colophon
15390% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
15391@end tex
15392
c906108c 15393@bye